Revision: miles@gnu.org--gnu-2005/emacs--unicode--0--patch-61
[bpt/emacs.git] / etc / NEWS
1 GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21
2 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 See the end for copying conditions.
5
6 Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
7 For older news, see the file ONEWS
8 You can narrow news to the specific version by calling
9 `view-emacs-news' with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n.
10
11 Temporary note:
12 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
13 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
14 When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
15 so we will look at it and add it to the manual.
16
17 Fixme: The notes about Emacs 23 are quite incomplete.
18
19 \f
20 * Changes in Emacs 23.1
21
22 ** The Emacs character set is now a superset of Unicode.
23 (It has about four times the code space, which should be plenty).
24
25 The internal encoding used for buffers and strings is now
26 Unicode-based and called `utf-8-emacs'. utf-8-emacs is backwards
27 compatible with the UTF-8 encoding of Unicode. The `emacs-mule'
28 coding system can still read and write data in the old internal
29 encoding.
30
31 There are still charsets which contain disjoint sets of characters
32 where this is necessary or useful, especially for various Far Eastern
33 sets which are problematic with Unicode.
34
35 Since the internal encoding is also used by default for byte-compiled
36 files -- i.e. the normal coding system for byte-compiled Lisp files is
37 now utf-8-Emacs -- Lisp containing non-ASCII characters which is
38 compiled by Emacs 23 can't be read by earlier versions of Emacs. Files
39 compiled by Emacs 20, 21, or 22 are loaded correctly as emacs-mule
40 (whether or not they contain multibyte characters), which makes loading
41 them somewhat slower than Emacs 23-compiled files. Thus it may be worth
42 recompiling existing .elc files which don't need to be shared with older
43 Emacsen.
44
45 ** There are assorted new coding systems/aliases -- see
46 M-x list-coding-systems.
47
48 ** New charset implementation with many new charsets.
49 See M-x list-character-sets. New charsets can be defined conveniently
50 as tables of unicodes.
51
52 The dimension of a charset is now 0, 1, 2, or 3, and the size of each
53 dimension is no longer limited to 94 or 96.
54
55 Generic characters no longer exist.
56
57 A dynamic charset priority list is used to infer the charset of
58 unicodes for display &c.
59
60 ** The following facilities are obsolete:
61
62 Minor modes: unify-8859-on-encoding-mode, unify-8859-on-decoding-mode
63
64 \f
65 * Lisp changes in Emacs 23.1
66
67 map-char-table's behaviour has changed.
68
69 New functions: characterp, max-char, map-charset-chars,
70 define-charset-alias, primary-charset, set-primary-charset,
71 unify-charset, clear-charset-maps, charset-priority-list,
72 set-charset-priority, define-coding-system,
73 define-coding-system-alias, coding-system-aliases, langinfo,
74 string-to-multibyte.
75
76 Changed functions: copy-sequence, decode-char, encode-char,
77 set-fontset-font, new-fontset, modify-syntax-entry, define-charset,
78 modify-category-entry
79
80 Obsoleted: char-bytes, chars-in-region, set-coding-priority,
81 char-valid-p
82
83 \f
84 * Incompatible Lisp changes
85
86 Deleted functions: make-coding-system, register-char-codings,
87 coding-system-spec
88
89 ** The character codes for characters from the
90 eight-bit-control/eight-bit-graphic charsets aren't now in the range
91 128-255.
92 \f
93 * Installation Changes in Emacs 22.1
94
95 ---
96 ** Emacs now supports new configure options `--program-prefix',
97 `--program-suffix' and `--program-transform-name' that affect the names of
98 installed programs.
99
100 ---
101 ** Emacs can now be built without sound support.
102
103 ---
104 ** You can build Emacs with Gtk+ widgets by specifying `--with-x-toolkit=gtk'
105 when you run configure. This requires Gtk+ 2.0 or newer. This port
106 provides a way to display multilingual text in menus (with some caveats).
107
108 ---
109 ** The `emacsserver' program has been removed, replaced with Lisp code.
110
111 ---
112 ** By default, Emacs now uses a setgid helper program to update game
113 scores. The directory ${localstatedir}/games/emacs is the normal
114 place for game scores to be stored. You can control this with the
115 configure option `--with-game-dir'. The specific user that Emacs uses
116 to own the game scores is controlled by `--with-game-user'. If access
117 to a game user is not available, then scores will be stored separately
118 in each user's home directory.
119
120 ---
121 ** Leim is now part of the Emacs distribution.
122 You no longer need to download a separate tarball in order to build
123 Emacs with Leim.
124
125 +++
126 ** The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is now part of the distribution.
127
128 The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual in Info format is built as part of the
129 Emacs build procedure and installed together with the Emacs User
130 Manual. A menu item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy
131 accessible (Help->More Manuals->Emacs Lisp Reference).
132
133 ---
134 ** The Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp manual is now part of
135 the distribution.
136
137 This manual is now part of the standard distribution and is installed,
138 together with the Emacs User Manual, into the Info directory. A menu
139 item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy accessible
140 (Help->More Manuals->Introduction to Emacs Lisp).
141
142 ---
143 ** New translations of the Emacs Tutorial are available in the
144 following languages: Brasilian Portuguese, Bulgarian, Chinese (both
145 with simplified and traditional characters), French, and Italian.
146 Type `C-u C-h t' to choose one of them in case your language setup
147 doesn't automatically select the right one.
148
149 ---
150 ** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
151
152 ---
153 ** Emacs now includes support for loading image libraries on demand.
154 (Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure
155 the supported image types and their associated dynamic libraries by
156 setting the variable `image-library-alist'.
157
158 ---
159 ** Support for Cygwin was added.
160
161 ---
162 ** Support for FreeBSD/Alpha has been added.
163
164 ---
165 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on S390 machines was added.
166
167 ---
168 ** Support for MacOS X was added.
169 See the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
170
171 ---
172 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on X86-64 machines was added.
173
174 ---
175 ** Mac OS 9 port now uses the Carbon API by default. You can also
176 create non-Carbon build by specifying `NonCarbon' as a target. See
177 the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
178
179 ---
180 ** Building with -DENABLE_CHECKING does not automatically build with union
181 types any more. Add -DUSE_LISP_UNION_TYPE if you want union types.
182
183 ---
184 ** When pure storage overflows while dumping, Emacs now prints how
185 much pure storage it will approximately need.
186
187 ** The script etc/emacs-buffer.gdb can be used with gdb to retrieve the
188 contents of buffers from a core dump and save them to files easily, should
189 emacs crash.
190
191 \f
192 * Startup Changes in Emacs 22.1
193
194 +++
195 ** New command line option -Q or --quick.
196 This is like using -q --no-site-file, but in addition it also disables
197 the fancy startup screen.
198
199 +++
200 ** New command line option -D or --basic-display.
201 Disables the menu-bar, the tool-bar, the scroll-bars, tool tips, and
202 the blinking cursor.
203
204 +++
205 ** New command line option -nbc or --no-blinking-cursor disables
206 the blinking cursor on graphical terminals.
207
208 +++
209 ** The option --script FILE runs Emacs in batch mode and loads FILE.
210 It is useful for writing Emacs Lisp shell script files, because they
211 can start with this line:
212
213 #!/usr/bin/emacs --script
214
215 +++
216 ** The option --directory DIR now modifies `load-path' immediately.
217 Directories are added to the front of `load-path' in the order they
218 appear on the command line. For example, with this command line:
219
220 emacs -batch -L .. -L /tmp --eval "(require 'foo)"
221
222 Emacs looks for library `foo' in the parent directory, then in /tmp, then
223 in the other directories in `load-path'. (-L is short for --directory.)
224
225 +++
226 ** The command line option --no-windows has been changed to
227 --no-window-system. The old one still works, but is deprecated.
228
229 +++
230 ** The -f option, used from the command line to call a function,
231 now reads arguments for the function interactively if it is
232 an interactively callable function.
233
234 +++
235 ** When you specify a frame size with --geometry, the size applies to
236 all frames you create. A position specified with --geometry only
237 affects the initial frame.
238
239 +++
240 ** Emacs can now be invoked in full-screen mode on a windowed display.
241 When Emacs is invoked on a window system, the new command-line options
242 `--fullwidth', `--fullheight', and `--fullscreen' produce a frame
243 whose width, height, or both width and height take up the entire
244 screen size. (For now, this does not work with some window managers.)
245
246 +++
247 ** Emacs now displays a splash screen by default even if command-line
248 arguments were given. The new command-line option --no-splash
249 disables the splash screen; see also the variable
250 `inhibit-startup-message' (which is also aliased as
251 `inhibit-splash-screen').
252
253 +++
254 ** New user option `inhibit-startup-buffer-menu'.
255 When loading many files, for instance with `emacs *', Emacs normally
256 displays a buffer menu. This option turns the buffer menu off.
257
258 +++
259 ** Init file changes
260 You can now put the init files .emacs and .emacs_SHELL under
261 ~/.emacs.d or directly under ~. Emacs will find them in either place.
262
263 +++
264 ** Emacs now reads the standard abbrevs file ~/.abbrev_defs
265 automatically at startup, if it exists. When Emacs offers to save
266 modified buffers, it saves the abbrevs too if they have changed. It
267 can do this either silently or asking for confirmation first,
268 according to the value of `save-abbrevs'.
269 \f
270 * Incompatible Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
271
272 +++
273 ** M-g is now a prefix key.
274 M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
275 M-g n and M-g M-n run next-error (like C-x `).
276 M-g p and M-g M-p run previous-error.
277
278 +++
279 ** C-u M-g M-g switches to the most recent previous buffer,
280 and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
281
282 When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
283 point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
284
285 +++
286 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
287 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
288 the operating system or your X server.
289
290 +++
291 ** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
292
293 +++
294 ** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
295 (beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
296 you about it.
297
298 +++
299 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
300 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
301
302 +++
303 ** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
304 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
305 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
306
307 +++
308 ** The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
309 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
310
311 +++
312 ** In incremental search, C-w is changed. M-%, C-M-w and C-M-y are special.
313
314 See below under "incremental search changes".
315
316 ---
317 ** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
318
319 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
320 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
321 directory with Dired.
322
323 +++
324 ** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
325 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
326 it remains unchanged.
327
328 +++
329 ** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
330 M-o M-o requests refontification.
331
332 +++
333 ** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
334
335 See below for more details.
336
337 +++
338 ** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
339 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
340 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
341 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
342 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
343 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
344 \f
345 * Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
346
347 +++
348 ** The max size of buffers and integers has been doubled.
349 On 32bit machines, it is now 256M (i.e. 268435455).
350
351 +++
352 ** M-g is now a prefix key.
353 M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
354 M-g n and M-g M-n run next-error (like C-x `).
355 M-g p and M-g M-p run previous-error.
356
357 +++
358 ** C-u M-g M-g switches to the most recent previous buffer,
359 and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
360
361 When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
362 point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
363
364 +++
365 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
366 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
367 the operating system or your X server.
368
369 +++
370 ** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
371
372 +++
373 ** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
374 (beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
375 you about it.
376
377 +++
378 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
379 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
380
381 +++
382 ** You can now switch buffers in a cyclic order with C-x C-left and
383 (prev-buffer) and C-x C-right (next-buffer). C-x left and C-x right
384 can be used as well.
385
386 +++
387 ** `undo-only' does an undo which does not redo any previous undo.
388
389 +++
390 ** M-SPC (just-one-space) when given a numeric argument N
391 converts whitespace around point to N spaces.
392
393 ---
394 ** New commands to operate on pairs of open and close characters:
395 `insert-pair', `delete-pair', `raise-sexp'.
396
397 ---
398 ** New command `kill-whole-line' kills an entire line at once.
399 By default, it is bound to C-S-<backspace>.
400
401 +++
402 ** Yanking text now discards certain text properties that can
403 be inconvenient when you did not expect them. The variable
404 `yank-excluded-properties' specifies which ones. Insertion
405 of register contents and rectangles also discards these properties.
406
407 +++
408 ** The default values of paragraph-start and indent-line-function have
409 been changed to reflect those used in Text mode rather than those used
410 in Indented-Text mode.
411
412 +++
413 ** M-x setenv now expands environment variable references.
414
415 Substrings of the form `$foo' and `${foo}' in the specified new value
416 now refer to the value of environment variable foo. To include a `$'
417 in the value, use `$$'.
418
419 +++
420 ** `special-display-buffer-names' and `special-display-regexps' now
421 understand two new boolean pseudo-frame-parameters `same-frame' and
422 `same-window'.
423
424 +++
425 ** The default for the paper size (variable ps-paper-type) is taken
426 from the locale.
427
428 ** The command `list-faces-display' now accepts a prefix arg.
429 When passed, the function prompts for a regular expression and lists
430 only faces matching this regexp.
431
432 ** Mark command changes:
433
434 +++
435 *** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
436 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
437 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
438
439 +++
440 *** Marking commands extend the region when invoked multiple times.
441
442 If you type C-M-SPC (mark-sexp), M-@ (mark-word), M-h
443 (mark-paragraph), or C-M-h (mark-defun) repeatedly, the marked region
444 extends each time, so you can mark the next two sexps with M-C-SPC
445 M-C-SPC, for example. This feature also works for
446 mark-end-of-sentence, if you bind that to a key. It also extends the
447 region when the mark is active in Transient Mark mode, regardless of
448 the last command. To start a new region with one of marking commands
449 in Transient Mark mode, you can deactivate the active region with C-g,
450 or set the new mark with C-SPC.
451
452 +++
453 *** M-h (mark-paragraph) now accepts a prefix arg.
454
455 With positive arg, M-h marks the current and the following paragraphs;
456 if the arg is negative, it marks the current and the preceding
457 paragraphs.
458
459 +++
460 *** Some commands do something special in Transient Mark mode when the
461 mark is active--for instance, they limit their operation to the
462 region. Even if you don't normally use Transient Mark mode, you might
463 want to get this behavior from a particular command. There are two
464 ways you can enable Transient Mark mode and activate the mark, for one
465 command only.
466
467 One method is to type C-SPC C-SPC; this enables Transient Mark mode
468 and sets the mark at point. The other method is to type C-u C-x C-x.
469 This enables Transient Mark mode temporarily but does not alter the
470 mark or the region.
471
472 After these commands, Transient Mark mode remains enabled until you
473 deactivate the mark. That typically happens when you type a command
474 that alters the buffer, but you can also deactivate the mark by typing
475 C-g.
476
477 +++
478 *** Movement commands `beginning-of-buffer', `end-of-buffer',
479 `beginning-of-defun', `end-of-defun' do not set the mark if the mark
480 is already active in Transient Mark mode.
481
482 ** Help command changes:
483
484 +++
485 *** Changes in C-h bindings:
486
487 C-h e displays the *Messages* buffer.
488
489 C-h followed by a control character is used for displaying files
490 that do not change:
491
492 C-h C-f displays the FAQ.
493 C-h C-e displays the PROBLEMS file.
494
495 The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
496 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
497
498 C-h c, C-h k, C-h w, and C-h f now handle remapped interactive commands.
499
500 - C-h c and C-h k report the actual command (after possible remapping)
501 run by the key sequence.
502
503 - C-h w and C-h f on a command which has been remapped now report the
504 command it is remapped to, and the keys which can be used to run
505 that command.
506
507 For example, if C-k is bound to kill-line, and kill-line is remapped
508 to new-kill-line, these commands now report:
509
510 - C-h c and C-h k C-k reports:
511 C-k runs the command new-kill-line
512
513 - C-h w and C-h f kill-line reports:
514 kill-line is remapped to new-kill-line which is on C-k, <deleteline>
515
516 - C-h w and C-h f new-kill-line reports:
517 new-kill-line is on C-k
518
519 ---
520 *** Help commands `describe-function' and `describe-key' now show function
521 arguments in lowercase italics on displays that support it. To change the
522 default, customize face `help-argument-name' or redefine the function
523 `help-default-arg-highlight'.
524
525 +++
526 *** C-h v and C-h f commands now include a hyperlink to the C source for
527 variables and functions defined in C (if the C source is available).
528
529 +++
530 *** Help mode now only makes hyperlinks for faces when the face name is
531 preceded or followed by the word `face'. It no longer makes
532 hyperlinks for variables without variable documentation, unless
533 preceded by one of the words `variable' or `option'. It now makes
534 hyperlinks to Info anchors (or nodes) if the anchor (or node) name is
535 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `info anchor' or `Info
536 anchor' (in addition to earlier `info node' and `Info node').
537
538 +++
539 *** The new command `describe-char' (C-u C-x =) pops up a buffer with
540 description various information about a character, including its
541 encodings and syntax, its text properties, how to input, overlays, and
542 widgets at point. You can get more information about some of them, by
543 clicking on mouse-sensitive areas or moving there and pressing RET.
544
545 +++
546 *** The command `list-text-properties-at' has been deleted because
547 C-u C-x = gives the same information and more.
548
549 +++
550 *** New command `display-local-help' displays any local help at point
551 in the echo area. It is bound to `C-h .'. It normally displays the
552 same string that would be displayed on mouse-over using the
553 `help-echo' property, but, in certain cases, it can display a more
554 keyboard oriented alternative.
555
556 +++
557 *** New user option `help-at-pt-display-when-idle' allows to
558 automatically show the help provided by `display-local-help' on
559 point-over, after suitable idle time. The amount of idle time is
560 determined by the user option `help-at-pt-timer-delay' and defaults
561 to one second. This feature is turned off by default.
562
563 +++
564 *** The apropos commands now accept a list of words to match.
565 When more than one word is specified, at least two of those words must
566 be present for an item to match. Regular expression matching is still
567 available.
568
569 +++
570 *** The new option `apropos-sort-by-scores' causes the matching items
571 to be sorted according to their score. The score for an item is a
572 number calculated to indicate how well the item matches the words or
573 regular expression that you entered to the apropos command. The best
574 match is listed first, and the calculated score is shown for each
575 matching item.
576
577 ** Incremental Search changes:
578
579 +++
580 *** Vertical scrolling is now possible within incremental search.
581 To enable this feature, customize the new user option
582 `isearch-allow-scroll'. User written commands which satisfy stringent
583 constraints can be marked as "scrolling commands". See the Emacs manual
584 for details.
585
586 +++
587 *** C-w in incremental search now grabs either a character or a word,
588 making the decision in a heuristic way. This new job is done by the
589 command `isearch-yank-word-or-char'. To restore the old behavior,
590 bind C-w to `isearch-yank-word' in `isearch-mode-map'.
591
592 +++
593 *** C-y in incremental search now grabs the next line if point is already
594 at the end of a line.
595
596 +++
597 *** C-M-w deletes and C-M-y grabs a character in isearch mode.
598 Another method to grab a character is to enter the minibuffer by `M-e'
599 and to type `C-f' at the end of the search string in the minibuffer.
600
601 +++
602 *** M-% typed in isearch mode invokes `query-replace' or
603 `query-replace-regexp' (depending on search mode) with the current
604 search string used as the string to replace.
605
606 +++
607 *** Isearch no longer adds `isearch-resume' commands to the command
608 history by default. To enable this feature, customize the new
609 user option `isearch-resume-in-command-history'.
610
611 ** Replace command changes:
612
613 ---
614 *** New user option `query-replace-skip-read-only': when non-nil,
615 `query-replace' and related functions simply ignore
616 a match if part of it has a read-only property.
617
618 +++
619 *** When used interactively, the commands `query-replace-regexp' and
620 `replace-regexp' allow \,expr to be used in a replacement string,
621 where expr is an arbitrary Lisp expression evaluated at replacement
622 time. In many cases, this will be more convenient than using
623 `query-replace-regexp-eval'. `\#' in a replacement string now refers
624 to the count of replacements already made by the replacement command.
625 All regular expression replacement commands now allow `\?' in the
626 replacement string to specify a position where the replacement string
627 can be edited for each replacement.
628
629 +++
630 *** query-replace uses isearch lazy highlighting when the new user option
631 `query-replace-lazy-highlight' is non-nil.
632
633 ---
634 *** The current match in query-replace is highlighted in new face
635 `query-replace' which by default inherits from isearch face.
636
637 ** File operation changes:
638
639 +++
640 *** Unquoted `$' in file names do not signal an error any more when
641 the corresponding environment variable does not exist.
642 Instead, the `$ENVVAR' text is left as is, so that `$$' quoting
643 is only rarely needed.
644
645 +++
646 *** In processing a local variables list, Emacs strips the prefix and
647 suffix are from every line before processing all the lines.
648
649 +++
650 *** find-file-read-only visits multiple files in read-only mode,
651 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
652
653 +++
654 *** find-alternate-file replaces the current file with multiple files,
655 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
656
657 +++
658 *** Auto Compression mode is now enabled by default.
659
660 ---
661 *** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
662
663 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
664 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
665 directory with Dired.
666
667 +++
668 *** When you are root, and you visit a file whose modes specify
669 read-only, the Emacs buffer is now read-only too. Type C-x C-q if you
670 want to make the buffer writable. (As root, you can in fact alter the
671 file.)
672
673 +++
674 *** C-x s (save-some-buffers) now offers an option `d' to diff a buffer
675 against its file, so you can see what changes you would be saving.
676
677 +++
678 *** The commands copy-file, rename-file, make-symbolic-link and
679 add-name-to-file, when given a directory as the "new name" argument,
680 convert it to a file name by merging in the within-directory part of
681 the existing file's name. (This is the same convention that shell
682 commands cp, mv, and ln follow.) Thus, M-x copy-file RET ~/foo RET
683 /tmp RET copies ~/foo to /tmp/foo.
684
685 ---
686 *** When used interactively, `format-write-file' now asks for confirmation
687 before overwriting an existing file, unless a prefix argument is
688 supplied. This behavior is analogous to `write-file'.
689
690 ---
691 *** The variable `auto-save-file-name-transforms' now has a third element that
692 controls whether or not the function `make-auto-save-file-name' will
693 attempt to construct a unique auto-save name (e.g. for remote files).
694
695 +++
696 *** If the user visits a file larger than `large-file-warning-threshold',
697 Emacs asks for confirmation.
698
699 +++
700 *** require-final-newline now has two new possible values:
701
702 `visit' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's needed
703 when visiting the file.
704
705 `visit-save' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's
706 needed when visiting the file, and also add a newline if it's needed
707 when saving the file.
708
709 +++
710 *** The new option mode-require-final-newline controls how certain
711 major modes enable require-final-newline. Any major mode that's
712 designed for a kind of file that should normally end in a newline
713 sets require-final-newline based on mode-require-final-newline.
714 So you can customize mode-require-final-newline to control what these
715 modes do.
716
717 ** Minibuffer changes:
718
719 +++
720 *** There's a new face `minibuffer-prompt'.
721 Emacs adds this face to the list of text properties stored in the
722 variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', which is used to display the
723 prompt string.
724
725 ---
726 *** Enhanced visual feedback in `*Completions*' buffer.
727
728 Completions lists use faces to highlight what all completions
729 have in common and where they begin to differ.
730
731 The common prefix shared by all possible completions uses the face
732 `completions-common-part', while the first character that isn't the
733 same uses the face `completions-first-difference'. By default,
734 `completions-common-part' inherits from `default', and
735 `completions-first-difference' inherits from `bold'. The idea of
736 `completions-common-part' is that you can use it to make the common
737 parts less visible than normal, so that the rest of the differing
738 parts is, by contrast, slightly highlighted.
739
740 +++
741 *** File-name completion can now ignore specified directories.
742 If an element of the list in `completion-ignored-extensions' ends in a
743 slash `/', it indicates a subdirectory that should be ignored when
744 completing file names. Elements of `completion-ignored-extensions'
745 which do not end in a slash are never considered when a completion
746 candidate is a directory.
747
748 +++
749 *** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
750 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
751 it remains unchanged.
752
753 +++
754 *** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'.
755 If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical
756 elements are deleted.
757
758 ** Redisplay changes:
759
760 +++
761 *** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
762 When the file is maintained under version control, that information
763 appears between the position information and the major mode.
764
765 +++
766 *** New face `escape-glyph' highlights control characters and escape glyphs.
767
768 +++
769 *** Non-breaking space and hyphens are now prefixed with an escape
770 character, unless the new user variable `show-nonbreak-escape' is set
771 to nil.
772
773 +++
774 *** The parameters of automatic hscrolling can now be customized.
775 The variable `hscroll-margin' determines how many columns away from
776 the window edge point is allowed to get before automatic hscrolling
777 will horizontally scroll the window. The default value is 5.
778
779 The variable `hscroll-step' determines how many columns automatic
780 hscrolling scrolls the window when point gets too close to the
781 window edge. If its value is zero, the default, Emacs scrolls the
782 window so as to center point. If its value is an integer, it says how
783 many columns to scroll. If the value is a floating-point number, it
784 gives the fraction of the window's width to scroll the window.
785
786 The variable `automatic-hscrolling' was renamed to
787 `auto-hscroll-mode'. The old name is still available as an alias.
788
789 ---
790 *** Moving or scrolling through images (and other lines) taller that
791 the window now works sensibly, by automatically adjusting the window's
792 vscroll property.
793
794 +++
795 *** The new face `mode-line-inactive' is used to display the mode line
796 of non-selected windows. The `mode-line' face is now used to display
797 the mode line of the currently selected window.
798
799 The new variable `mode-line-in-non-selected-windows' controls whether
800 the `mode-line-inactive' face is used.
801
802 +++
803 *** You can now customize the use of window fringes. To control this
804 for all frames, use M-x fringe-mode or the Show/Hide submenu of the
805 top-level Options menu, or customize the `fringe-mode' variable. To
806 control this for a specific frame, use the command M-x
807 set-fringe-style.
808
809 +++
810 *** Angle icons in the fringes can indicate the buffer boundaries. In
811 addition, up and down arrow bitmaps in the fringe indicate which ways
812 the window can be scrolled.
813
814 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
815 `indicate-buffer-boundaries' to a non-nil value. The default value of
816 this variable is found in `default-indicate-buffer-boundaries'.
817
818 If value is `left' or `right', both angle and arrow bitmaps are
819 displayed in the left or right fringe, resp.
820
821 The value can also be an alist which specifies the presence and
822 position of each bitmap individually.
823
824 For example, ((top . left) (t . right)) places the top angle bitmap
825 in left fringe, the bottom angle bitmap in right fringe, and both
826 arrow bitmaps in right fringe. To show just the angle bitmaps in the
827 left fringe, but no arrow bitmaps, use ((top . left) (bottom . left)).
828
829 +++
830 *** On window systems, lines which are exactly as wide as the window
831 (not counting the final newline character) are no longer broken into
832 two lines on the display (with just the newline on the second line).
833 Instead, the newline now "overflows" into the right fringe, and the
834 cursor will be displayed in the fringe when positioned on that newline.
835
836 The new user option 'overflow-newline-into-fringe' can be set to nil to
837 revert to the old behavior of continuing such lines.
838
839 +++
840 *** When a window has display margin areas, the fringes are now
841 displayed between the margins and the buffer's text area, rather than
842 outside those margins.
843
844 +++
845 *** A window can now have individual fringe and scroll-bar settings,
846 in addition to the individual display margin settings.
847
848 Such individual settings are now preserved when windows are split
849 horizontally or vertically, a saved window configuration is restored,
850 or when the frame is resized.
851
852 ** Cursor display changes:
853
854 +++
855 *** On X, MS Windows, and Mac OS, the blinking cursor's "off" state is
856 now controlled by the variable `blink-cursor-alist'.
857
858 +++
859 *** The X resource cursorBlink can be used to turn off cursor blinking.
860
861 +++
862 *** Emacs can produce an underscore-like (horizontal bar) cursor.
863 The underscore cursor is set by putting `(cursor-type . hbar)' in
864 default-frame-alist. It supports variable heights, like the `bar'
865 cursor does.
866
867 +++
868 *** Display of hollow cursors now obeys the buffer-local value (if any)
869 of `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' in the buffer that the cursor
870 appears in.
871
872 +++
873 *** The variable `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' can now be set to any
874 of the recognized cursor types.
875
876 ** New faces:
877
878 +++
879 *** `mode-line-highlight' is the standard face indicating mouse sensitive
880 elements on mode-line (and header-line) like `highlight' face on text
881 areas.
882
883 +++
884 *** `shadow' face defines the appearance of the "shadowed" text, i.e.
885 the text which should be less noticeable than the surrounding text.
886 This can be achieved by using shades of grey in contrast with either
887 black or white default foreground color. This generic shadow face
888 allows customization of the appearance of shadowed text in one place,
889 so package-specific faces can inherit from it.
890
891 ** Font-Lock changes:
892
893 +++
894 *** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
895 M-o M-o requests refontification.
896
897 +++
898 *** All modes now support using M-x font-lock-mode to toggle
899 fontification, even those such as Occur, Info, and comint-derived
900 modes that do their own fontification in a special way.
901
902 The variable `Info-fontify' is no longer applicable; to disable
903 fontification in Info, remove `turn-on-font-lock' from
904 `Info-mode-hook'.
905
906 +++
907 *** font-lock-lines-before specifies a number of lines before the
908 current line that should be refontified when you change the buffer.
909 The default value is 1.
910
911 +++
912 *** font-lock: in modes like C and Lisp where the fontification assumes that
913 an open-paren in column 0 is always outside of any string or comment,
914 font-lock now highlights any such open-paren-in-column-zero in bold-red
915 if it is inside a string or a comment, to indicate that it can cause
916 trouble with fontification and/or indentation.
917
918 +++
919 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-preprocessor-face'.
920
921 +++
922 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-comment-delimiter-face'.
923
924 +++
925 *** Easy to overlook single character negation can now be font-locked.
926 You can use the new variable `font-lock-negation-char-face' and the face of
927 the same name to customize this. Currently the cc-modes, sh-script-mode,
928 cperl-mode and make-mode support this.
929
930 ---
931 *** The default settings for JIT stealth lock parameters are changed.
932 The default value for the user option jit-lock-stealth-time is now 16
933 instead of 3, and the default value of jit-lock-stealth-nice is now
934 0.5 instead of 0.125. The new defaults should lower the CPU usage
935 when Emacs is fontifying in the background.
936
937 ---
938 *** jit-lock can now be delayed with `jit-lock-defer-time'.
939
940 If this variable is non-nil, its value should be the amount of Emacs
941 idle time in seconds to wait before starting fontification. For
942 example, if you set `jit-lock-defer-time' to 0.25, fontification will
943 only happen after 0.25s of idle time.
944
945 ---
946 *** contextual refontification is now separate from stealth fontification.
947
948 jit-lock-defer-contextually is renamed jit-lock-contextually and
949 jit-lock-context-time determines the delay after which contextual
950 refontification takes place.
951
952 ** Menu support:
953
954 ---
955 *** A menu item "Show/Hide" was added to the top-level menu "Options".
956 This menu allows you to turn various display features on and off (such
957 as the fringes, the tool bar, the speedbar, and the menu bar itself).
958 You can also move the vertical scroll bar to either side here or turn
959 it off completely. There is also a menu-item to toggle displaying of
960 current date and time, current line and column number in the
961 mode-line.
962
963 ---
964 *** Speedbar has moved from the "Tools" top level menu to "Show/Hide".
965
966 ---
967 *** You can exit dialog windows and menus by typing C-g.
968
969 ---
970 *** The menu item "Open File..." has been split into two items, "New File..."
971 and "Open File...". "Open File..." now opens only existing files. This is
972 to support existing GUI file selection dialogs better.
973
974 +++
975 *** The file selection dialog for Gtk+, Mac, W32 and Motif/Lesstif can be
976 disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'.
977
978 ---
979 *** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can
980 be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+, Mac and W32).
981
982 +++
983 *** The Lucid menus can display multilingual text in your locale. You have
984 to explicitly specify a fontSet resource for this to work, for example
985 `-xrm "Emacs*fontSet: -*-helvetica-medium-r-*--*-120-*-*-*-*-*-*,*"'.
986
987 ---
988 *** Dialogs for Lucid/Athena and Lesstif/Motif now pops down when pressing
989 ESC, like they do for Gtk+, Mac and W32.
990
991 +++
992 *** For Gtk+ version 2.4, you can make Emacs use the old file dialog
993 by setting the variable `x-use-old-gtk-file-dialog' to t. Default is to use
994 the new dialog.
995
996 ** Mouse changes:
997
998 +++
999 *** New display feature: focus follows the mouse from one Emacs window
1000 to another, even within a frame. If you set the variable
1001 mouse-autoselect-window to non-nil value, moving the mouse to a
1002 different Emacs window will select that window (minibuffer window can
1003 be selected only when it is active). The default is nil, so that this
1004 feature is not enabled.
1005
1006 +++
1007 *** On X, when the window manager requires that you click on a frame to
1008 select it (give it focus), the selected window and cursor position
1009 normally changes according to the mouse click position. If you set
1010 the variable x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position to t, the selected
1011 window and cursor position do not change when you click on a frame
1012 to give it focus.
1013
1014 +++
1015 *** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
1016
1017 Traditionally, Emacs uses a Mouse-1 click to set point and a Mouse-2
1018 click to follow a link, whereas most other applications use a Mouse-1
1019 click for both purposes, depending on whether you click outside or
1020 inside a link. Now the behavior of a Mouse-1 click has been changed
1021 to match this context-sentitive dual behavior. (If you prefer the old
1022 behavior, set the user option `mouse-1-click-follows-link' to nil.)
1023
1024 Depending on the current mode, a Mouse-2 click in Emacs can do much
1025 more than just follow a link, so the new Mouse-1 behavior is only
1026 activated for modes which explicitly mark a clickable text as a "link"
1027 (see the new function `mouse-on-link-p' for details). The Lisp
1028 packages that are included in release 22.1 have been adapted to do
1029 this, but external packages may not yet support this. However, there
1030 is no risk in using such packages, as the worst thing that could
1031 happen is that you get the original Mouse-1 behavior when you click
1032 on a link, which typically means that you set point where you click.
1033
1034 If you want to get the original Mouse-1 action also inside a link, you
1035 just need to press the Mouse-1 button a little longer than a normal
1036 click (i.e. press and hold the Mouse-1 button for half a second before
1037 you release it).
1038
1039 Dragging the Mouse-1 inside a link still performs the original
1040 drag-mouse-1 action, typically copy the text.
1041
1042 You can customize the new Mouse-1 behavior via the new user options
1043 `mouse-1-click-follows-link' and `mouse-1-click-in-non-selected-windows'.
1044
1045 +++
1046 *** Emacs normally highlights mouse sensitive text whenever the mouse
1047 is over the text. By setting the new variable `mouse-highlight', you
1048 can optionally enable mouse highlighting only after you move the
1049 mouse, so that highlighting disappears when you press a key. You can
1050 also disable mouse highlighting.
1051
1052 +++
1053 *** You can now customize if selecting a region by dragging the mouse
1054 shall not copy the selected text to the kill-ring by setting the new
1055 variable mouse-drag-copy-region to nil.
1056
1057 ---
1058 *** mouse-wheels can now scroll a specific fraction of the window
1059 (rather than a fixed number of lines) and the scrolling is `progressive'.
1060
1061 ---
1062 *** Emacs ignores mouse-2 clicks while the mouse wheel is being moved.
1063
1064 People tend to push the mouse wheel (which counts as a mouse-2 click)
1065 unintentionally while turning the wheel, so these clicks are now
1066 ignored. You can customize this with the mouse-wheel-click-event and
1067 mouse-wheel-inhibit-click-time variables.
1068
1069 +++
1070 *** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
1071
1072 ** Mule changes:
1073
1074 ---
1075 *** Language environment and various default coding systems are setup
1076 more correctly according to the current locale name. If the locale
1077 name doesn't specify a charset, the default is what glibc defines.
1078 This change can result in using the different coding systems as
1079 default in some locale (e.g. vi_VN).
1080
1081 +++
1082 *** The keyboard-coding-system is now automatically set based on your
1083 current locale settings if you are not using a window system. This
1084 can mean that the META key doesn't work but generates non-ASCII
1085 characters instead, depending on how the terminal (or terminal
1086 emulator) works. Use `set-keyboard-coding-system' (or customize
1087 keyboard-coding-system) if you prefer META to work (the old default)
1088 or if the locale doesn't describe the character set actually generated
1089 by the keyboard. See Info node `Single-Byte Character Support'.
1090
1091 +++
1092 *** The new command `revert-buffer-with-coding-system' (C-x RET r)
1093 revisits the current file using a coding system that you specify.
1094
1095 +++
1096 *** New command `recode-region' decodes the region again by a specified
1097 coding system.
1098
1099 +++
1100 *** The new command `recode-file-name' changes the encoding of the name
1101 of a file.
1102
1103 ---
1104 *** New command `ucs-insert' inserts a character specified by its
1105 unicode.
1106
1107 +++
1108 *** The new command `set-file-name-coding-system' (C-x RET F) sets
1109 coding system for encoding and decoding file names. A new menu item
1110 (Options->Mule->Set Coding Systems->For File Name) invokes this
1111 command.
1112
1113 +++
1114 *** New command quail-show-key shows what key (or key sequence) to type
1115 in the current input method to input a character at point.
1116
1117 +++
1118 *** Limited support for character `unification' has been added.
1119 Emacs now knows how to translate between different representations of
1120 the same characters in various Emacs charsets according to standard
1121 Unicode mappings. This applies mainly to characters in the ISO 8859
1122 sets plus some other 8-bit sets, but can be extended. For instance,
1123 translation works amongst the Emacs ...-iso8859-... charsets and the
1124 mule-unicode-... ones.
1125
1126 By default this translation happens automatically on encoding.
1127 Self-inserting characters are translated to make the input conformant
1128 with the encoding of the buffer in which it's being used, where
1129 possible.
1130
1131 You can force a more complete unification with the user option
1132 unify-8859-on-decoding-mode. That maps all the Latin-N character sets
1133 into Unicode characters (from the latin-iso8859-1 and
1134 mule-unicode-0100-24ff charsets) on decoding. Note that this mode
1135 will often effectively clobber data with an iso-2022 encoding.
1136
1137 ---
1138 *** There is support for decoding Greek and Cyrillic characters into
1139 either Unicode (the mule-unicode charsets) or the iso-8859 charsets,
1140 when possible. The latter are more space-efficient. This is
1141 controlled by user option utf-fragment-on-decoding.
1142
1143 ---
1144 *** New language environments: French, Ukrainian, Tajik,
1145 Bulgarian, Belarusian, Ukrainian, UTF-8, Windows-1255, Welsh, Latin-6,
1146 Latin-7, Lithuanian, Latvian, Swedish, Slovenian, Croatian, Georgian,
1147 Italian, Russian, Malayalam, Tamil, Russian, Chinese-EUC-TW. (Set up
1148 automatically according to the locale.)
1149
1150 ---
1151 *** New input methods: latin-alt-postfix, latin-postfix, latin-prefix,
1152 ukrainian-computer, belarusian, bulgarian-bds, russian-computer,
1153 vietnamese-telex, lithuanian-numeric, lithuanian-keyboard,
1154 latvian-keyboard, welsh, georgian, rfc1345, ucs, sgml,
1155 bulgarian-phonetic, dutch, slovenian, croatian, malayalam-inscript,
1156 tamil-inscript.
1157
1158 ---
1159 *** New input method chinese-sisheng for inputting Chinese Pinyin
1160 characters.
1161
1162 ---
1163 *** Improved Thai support. A new minor mode `thai-word-mode' (which is
1164 automatically activated if you select Thai as a language
1165 environment) changes key bindings of most word-oriented commands to
1166 versions which recognize Thai words. Affected commands are
1167 M-f (forward-word)
1168 M-b (backward-word)
1169 M-d (kill-word)
1170 M-DEL (backward-kill-word)
1171 M-t (transpose-words)
1172 M-q (fill-paragraph)
1173
1174 ---
1175 *** Indian support has been updated.
1176 The in-is13194 coding system is now Unicode-based. CDAC fonts are
1177 assumed. There is a framework for supporting various
1178 Indian scripts, but currently only Devanagari, Malayalam and Tamil are
1179 supported.
1180
1181 ---
1182 *** A UTF-7 coding system is available in the library `utf-7'.
1183
1184 ---
1185 *** The utf-8/16 coding systems have been enhanced.
1186 By default, untranslatable utf-8 sequences are simply composed into
1187 single quasi-characters. User option `utf-translate-cjk-mode' (it is
1188 turned on by default) arranges to translate many utf-8 CJK character
1189 sequences into real Emacs characters in a similar way to the Mule-UCS
1190 system. As this loads a fairly big data on demand, people who are not
1191 interested in CJK characters may want to customize it to nil.
1192 You can augment/amend the CJK translation via hash tables
1193 `ucs-mule-cjk-to-unicode' and `ucs-unicode-to-mule-cjk'. The utf-8
1194 coding system now also encodes characters from most of Emacs's
1195 one-dimensional internal charsets, specifically the ISO-8859 ones.
1196 The utf-16 coding system is affected similarly.
1197
1198 ---
1199 *** A new coding system `euc-tw' has been added for traditional Chinese
1200 in CNS encoding; it accepts both Big 5 and CNS as input; on saving,
1201 Big 5 is then converted to CNS.
1202
1203 ---
1204 *** Many new coding systems are available by loading the `code-pages'
1205 library. These include complete versions of most of those in
1206 codepage.el, based on Unicode mappings. `codepage-setup' is now
1207 obsolete and is used only in the MS-DOS port of Emacs. windows-1252
1208 and windows-1251 are preloaded since the former is so common and the
1209 latter is used by GNU locales.
1210
1211 ---
1212 *** New variable `utf-translate-cjk-unicode-range' controls which
1213 Unicode characters to translate in `utf-translate-cjk-mode'.
1214
1215 ---
1216 *** iso-10646-1 (`Unicode') fonts can be used to display any range of
1217 characters encodable by the utf-8 coding system. Just specify the
1218 fontset appropriately.
1219
1220 ** Customize changes:
1221
1222 +++
1223 *** The commands M-x customize-face and M-x customize-face-other-window
1224 now look at the character after point. If a face or faces are
1225 specified for that character, the commands by default customize those
1226 faces.
1227
1228 ---
1229 *** The face-customization widget has been reworked to be less confusing.
1230 In particular, when you enable a face attribute using the corresponding
1231 check-box, there's no longer a redundant `*' option in value selection
1232 for that attribute; the values you can choose are only those which make
1233 sense for the attribute. When an attribute is de-selected by unchecking
1234 its check-box, then the (now ignored, but still present temporarily in
1235 case you re-select the attribute) value is hidden.
1236
1237 +++
1238 *** When you set or reset a variable's value in a Customize buffer,
1239 the previous value becomes the "backup value" of the variable.
1240 You can go back to that backup value by selecting "Use Backup Value"
1241 under the "[State]" button.
1242
1243 ** Buffer Menu changes:
1244
1245 +++
1246 *** New command `Buffer-menu-toggle-files-only' toggles display of file
1247 buffers only in the Buffer Menu. It is bound to `T' in Buffer Menu
1248 mode.
1249
1250 +++
1251 *** `buffer-menu' and `list-buffers' now list buffers whose names begin
1252 with a space, when those buffers are visiting files. Normally buffers
1253 whose names begin with space are omitted.
1254
1255 ---
1256 *** The new options `buffers-menu-show-directories' and
1257 `buffers-menu-show-status' let you control how buffers are displayed
1258 in the menu dropped down when you click "Buffers" from the menu bar.
1259
1260 `buffers-menu-show-directories' controls whether the menu displays
1261 leading directories as part of the file name visited by the buffer.
1262 If its value is `unless-uniquify', the default, directories are
1263 shown unless uniquify-buffer-name-style' is non-nil. The value of nil
1264 and t turn the display of directories off and on, respectively.
1265
1266 `buffers-menu-show-status' controls whether the Buffers menu includes
1267 the modified and read-only status of the buffers. By default it is
1268 t, and the status is shown.
1269
1270 Setting these variables directly does not take effect until next time
1271 the Buffers menu is regenerated.
1272
1273 ** Dired mode:
1274
1275 ---
1276 *** New faces dired-header, dired-mark, dired-marked, dired-flagged,
1277 dired-ignored, dired-directory, dired-symlink, dired-warning
1278 introduced for Dired mode instead of font-lock faces.
1279
1280 +++
1281 *** New Dired command `dired-compare-directories' marks files
1282 with different file attributes in two dired buffers.
1283
1284 +++
1285 *** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps
1286 of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer.
1287
1288 +++
1289 *** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
1290 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
1291 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
1292 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
1293 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
1294 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
1295
1296 +++
1297 *** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name
1298 into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, copies absolute file names.
1299
1300 +++
1301 *** In Dired-x, Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode.
1302
1303 The mode toggling command is bound to M-o. A new command
1304 dired-mark-omitted, bound to * O, marks omitted files. The variable
1305 dired-omit-files-p is obsoleted, use the mode toggling function
1306 instead.
1307
1308 +++
1309 *** The variables dired-free-space-program and dired-free-space-args
1310 have been renamed to directory-free-space-program and
1311 directory-free-space-args, and they now apply whenever Emacs puts a
1312 directory listing into a buffer.
1313
1314 ** Comint changes:
1315
1316 ---
1317 *** The comint prompt can now be made read-only, using the new user
1318 option `comint-prompt-read-only'. This is not enabled by default,
1319 except in IELM buffers. The read-only status of IELM prompts can be
1320 controlled with the new user option `ielm-prompt-read-only', which
1321 overrides `comint-prompt-read-only'.
1322
1323 The new commands `comint-kill-whole-line' and `comint-kill-region'
1324 support editing comint buffers with read-only prompts.
1325
1326 `comint-kill-whole-line' is like `kill-whole-line', but ignores both
1327 read-only and field properties. Hence, it always kill entire
1328 lines, including any prompts.
1329
1330 `comint-kill-region' is like `kill-region', except that it ignores
1331 read-only properties, if it is safe to do so. This means that if any
1332 part of a prompt is deleted, then the entire prompt must be deleted
1333 and that all prompts must stay at the beginning of a line. If this is
1334 not the case, then `comint-kill-region' behaves just like
1335 `kill-region' if read-only are involved: it copies the text to the
1336 kill-ring, but does not delete it.
1337
1338 +++
1339 *** The new command `comint-insert-previous-argument' in comint-derived
1340 modes (shell-mode etc) inserts arguments from previous command lines,
1341 like bash's `ESC .' binding. It is bound by default to `C-c .', but
1342 otherwise behaves quite similarly to the bash version.
1343
1344 +++
1345 *** `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields' has been renamed
1346 `comint-use-prompt-regexp'. The old name has been kept as an alias,
1347 but declared obsolete.
1348
1349 ** M-x Compile changes:
1350
1351 ---
1352 *** M-x compile has become more robust and reliable
1353
1354 Quite a few more kinds of messages are recognized. Messages that are
1355 recognized as warnings or informational come in orange or green, instead of
1356 red. Informational messages are by default skipped with `next-error'
1357 (controlled by `compilation-skip-threshold').
1358
1359 Location data is collected on the fly as the *compilation* buffer changes.
1360 This means you could modify messages to make them point to different files.
1361 This also means you can not go to locations of messages you may have deleted.
1362
1363 The variable `compilation-error-regexp-alist' has now become customizable. If
1364 you had added your own regexps to this, you'll probably need to include a
1365 leading `^', otherwise they'll match anywhere on a line. There is now also a
1366 `compilation-mode-font-lock-keywords' and it nicely handles all the checks
1367 that configure outputs and -o options so you see at a glance where you are.
1368
1369 The new file etc/compilation.txt gives examples of each type of message.
1370
1371 +++
1372 *** New user option `compilation-environment'.
1373 This option allows you to specify environment variables for inferior
1374 compilation processes without affecting the environment that all
1375 subprocesses inherit.
1376
1377 +++
1378 *** New options `next-error-highlight' and `next-error-highlight-no-select'
1379 specify the method of highlighting of the corresponding source line
1380 in new face `next-error'.
1381
1382 +++
1383 *** A new minor mode `next-error-follow-minor-mode' can be used in
1384 compilation-mode, grep-mode, occur-mode, and diff-mode (i.e. all the
1385 modes that can use `next-error'). In this mode, cursor motion in the
1386 buffer causes automatic display in another window of the corresponding
1387 matches, compilation errors, etc. This minor mode can be toggled with
1388 C-c C-f.
1389
1390 +++
1391 *** When the left fringe is displayed, an arrow points to current message in
1392 the compilation buffer.
1393
1394 +++
1395 *** The new variable `compilation-context-lines' controls lines of leading
1396 context before the current message. If nil and the left fringe is displayed,
1397 it doesn't scroll the compilation output window. If there is no left fringe,
1398 no arrow is displayed and a value of nil means display the message at the top
1399 of the window.
1400
1401 ** Occur mode changes:
1402
1403 +++
1404 *** In the *Occur* buffer, `o' switches to it in another window, and
1405 C-o displays the current line's occurrence in another window without
1406 switching to it.
1407
1408 +++
1409 *** You can now use next-error (C-x `) and previous-error to advance to
1410 the next/previous matching line found by M-x occur.
1411
1412 +++
1413 *** The new command `multi-occur' is just like `occur', except it can
1414 search multiple buffers. There is also a new command
1415 `multi-occur-by-filename-regexp' which allows you to specify the
1416 buffers to search by their filename. Internally, Occur mode has been
1417 rewritten, and now uses font-lock, among other changes.
1418
1419 ** Grep changes:
1420
1421 +++
1422 *** Grep has been decoupled from compilation mode setup.
1423
1424 There's a new separate package grep.el, with its own submenu and
1425 customization group.
1426
1427 ---
1428 *** M-x grep provides highlighting support.
1429
1430 Hits are fontified in green, and hits in binary files in orange. Grep buffers
1431 can be saved and automatically revisited.
1432
1433 +++
1434 *** `grep-find' is now also available under the name `find-grep' where
1435 people knowing `find-grep-dired' would probably expect it.
1436
1437 ---
1438 *** The new variables `grep-window-height', `grep-auto-highlight', and
1439 `grep-scroll-output' override the corresponding compilation mode
1440 settings, for grep commands only.
1441
1442 +++
1443 *** New option `grep-highlight-matches' highlightes matches in *grep*
1444 buffer. It uses a special feature of some grep programs which accept
1445 --color option to output markers around matches. When going to the next
1446 match with `next-error' the exact match is highlighted in the source
1447 buffer. Otherwise, if `grep-highlight-matches' is nil, the whole
1448 source line is highlighted.
1449
1450 +++
1451 *** New key bindings in grep output window:
1452 SPC and DEL scrolls window up and down. C-n and C-p moves to next and
1453 previous match in the grep window. RET jumps to the source line of
1454 the current match. `n' and `p' shows next and previous match in
1455 other window, but does not switch buffer. `{' and `}' jumps to the
1456 previous or next file in the grep output. TAB also jumps to the next
1457 file.
1458
1459 +++
1460 *** M-x grep now tries to avoid appending `/dev/null' to the command line
1461 by using GNU grep `-H' option instead. M-x grep automatically
1462 detects whether this is possible or not the first time it is invoked.
1463 When `-H' is used, the grep command line supplied by the user is passed
1464 unchanged to the system to execute, which allows more complicated
1465 command lines to be used than was possible before.
1466
1467 ** X Windows Support:
1468
1469 +++
1470 *** Emacs now supports drag and drop for X. Dropping a file on a window
1471 opens it, dropping text inserts the text. Dropping a file on a dired
1472 buffer copies or moves the file to that directory.
1473
1474 +++
1475 *** Under X11, it is possible to swap Alt and Meta (and Super and Hyper).
1476 The new variables `x-alt-keysym', `x-hyper-keysym', `x-meta-keysym',
1477 and `x-super-keysym' can be used to choose which keysyms Emacs should
1478 use for the modifiers. For example, the following two lines swap
1479 Meta and Alt:
1480 (setq x-alt-keysym 'meta)
1481 (setq x-meta-keysym 'alt)
1482
1483 +++
1484 *** The X resource useXIM can be used to turn off use of XIM, which can
1485 speed up Emacs with slow networking to the X server.
1486
1487 If the configure option `--without-xim' was used to turn off use of
1488 XIM by default, the X resource useXIM can be used to turn it on.
1489
1490 ---
1491 *** The new variable `x-select-request-type' controls how Emacs
1492 requests X selection. The default value is nil, which means that
1493 Emacs requests X selection with types COMPOUND_TEXT and UTF8_STRING,
1494 and use the more appropriately result.
1495
1496 ---
1497 *** The scrollbar under LessTif or Motif has a smoother drag-scrolling.
1498 On the other hand, the size of the thumb does not represent the actual
1499 amount of text shown any more (only a crude approximation of it).
1500
1501 ** Xterm support:
1502
1503 ---
1504 *** Emacs now responds to mouse-clicks on the mode-line, header-line and
1505 display margin, when run in an xterm.
1506
1507 ---
1508 *** Improved key bindings support when running in an xterm.
1509 When emacs is running in an xterm more key bindings are available. The
1510 following should work:
1511 {C,S,C-S,A}-{right,left,up,down,prior,next,delete,insert,F1-12}.
1512 These key bindings work on xterm from X.org 6.8, they might not work on
1513 some older versions of xterm, or on some proprietary versions.
1514
1515 ** Character terminal color support changes:
1516
1517 +++
1518 *** The new command-line option --color=MODE lets you specify a standard
1519 mode for a tty color support. It is meant to be used on character
1520 terminals whose capabilities are not set correctly in the terminal
1521 database, or with terminal emulators which support colors, but don't
1522 set the TERM environment variable to a name of a color-capable
1523 terminal. "emacs --color" uses the same color commands as GNU `ls'
1524 when invoked with "ls --color", so if your terminal can support colors
1525 in "ls --color", it will support "emacs --color" as well. See the
1526 user manual for the possible values of the MODE parameter.
1527
1528 ---
1529 *** Emacs now supports several character terminals which provide more
1530 than 8 colors. For example, for `xterm', 16-color, 88-color, and
1531 256-color modes are supported. Emacs automatically notes at startup
1532 the extended number of colors, and defines the appropriate entries for
1533 all of these colors.
1534
1535 +++
1536 *** Emacs now uses the full range of available colors for the default
1537 faces when running on a color terminal, including 16-, 88-, and
1538 256-color xterms. This means that when you run "emacs -nw" on an
1539 88-color or 256-color xterm, you will see essentially the same face
1540 colors as on X.
1541
1542 ---
1543 *** There's a new support for colors on `rxvt' terminal emulator.
1544 \f
1545 * New Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1
1546
1547 +++
1548 ** Filesets are collections of files. You can define a fileset in
1549 various ways, such as based on a directory tree or based on
1550 program files that include other program files.
1551
1552 Once you have defined a fileset, you can perform various operations on
1553 all the files in it, such as visiting them or searching and replacing
1554 in them.
1555
1556 +++
1557 ** Calc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1558
1559 Calc is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool written in
1560 Emacs Lisp. Its documentation is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
1561 type "C-h i m calc RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
1562 available in `etc/calccard.tex' and `etc/calccard.ps'.
1563
1564 ---
1565 ** The new package ibuffer provides a powerful, completely
1566 customizable replacement for buff-menu.el.
1567
1568 ---
1569 ** Ido mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1570
1571 The ido (interactively do) package is an extension of the iswitchb
1572 package to do interactive opening of files and directories in addition
1573 to interactive buffer switching. Ido is a superset of iswitchb (with
1574 a few exceptions), so don't enable both packages.
1575
1576 +++
1577 ** Image files are normally visited in Image mode, which lets you toggle
1578 between viewing the image and viewing the text using C-c C-c.
1579
1580 ---
1581 ** CUA mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1582
1583 The new cua package provides CUA-like keybindings using C-x for
1584 cut (kill), C-c for copy, C-v for paste (yank), and C-z for undo.
1585 With cua, the region can be set and extended using shifted movement
1586 keys (like pc-selection-mode) and typed text replaces the active
1587 region (like delete-selection-mode). Do not enable these modes with
1588 cua-mode. Customize the variable `cua-mode' to enable cua.
1589
1590 In addition, cua provides unified rectangle support with visible
1591 rectangle highlighting: Use C-return to start a rectangle, extend it
1592 using the movement commands (or mouse-3), and cut or copy it using C-x
1593 or C-c (using C-w and M-w also works).
1594
1595 Use M-o and M-c to `open' or `close' the rectangle, use M-b or M-f, to
1596 fill it with blanks or another character, use M-u or M-l to upcase or
1597 downcase the rectangle, use M-i to increment the numbers in the
1598 rectangle, use M-n to fill the rectangle with a numeric sequence (such
1599 as 10 20 30...), use M-r to replace a regexp in the rectangle, and use
1600 M-' or M-/ to restrict command on the rectangle to a subset of the
1601 rows. See the commentary in cua-base.el for more rectangle commands.
1602
1603 Cua also provides unified support for registers: Use a numeric
1604 prefix argument between 0 and 9, i.e. M-0 .. M-9, for C-x, C-c, and
1605 C-v to cut or copy into register 0-9, or paste from register 0-9.
1606
1607 The last text deleted (not killed) is automatically stored in
1608 register 0. This includes text deleted by typing text.
1609
1610 Finally, cua provides a global mark which is set using S-C-space.
1611 When the global mark is active, any text which is cut or copied is
1612 automatically inserted at the global mark position. See the
1613 commentary in cua-base.el for more global mark related commands.
1614
1615 The features of cua also works with the standard emacs bindings for
1616 kill, copy, yank, and undo. If you want to use cua mode, but don't
1617 want the C-x, C-c, C-v, and C-z bindings, you can customize the
1618 `cua-enable-cua-keys' variable.
1619
1620 Note: This version of cua mode is not backwards compatible with older
1621 versions of cua.el and cua-mode.el. To ensure proper operation, you
1622 must remove older versions of cua.el or cua-mode.el as well as the
1623 loading and customization of those packages from the .emacs file.
1624
1625 +++
1626 ** The new package dns-mode.el add syntax highlight of DNS master files.
1627 The key binding C-c C-s (`dns-mode-soa-increment-serial') can be used
1628 to increment the SOA serial.
1629
1630 ---
1631 ** The new global minor mode `file-name-shadow-mode' modifies the way
1632 filenames being entered by the user in the minibuffer are displayed, so
1633 that it's clear when part of the entered filename will be ignored due to
1634 emacs' filename parsing rules. The ignored portion can be made dim,
1635 invisible, or otherwise less visually noticable. The display method can
1636 be displayed by customizing the variable `file-name-shadow-properties'.
1637
1638 +++
1639 ** The new package flymake.el does on-the-fly syntax checking of program
1640 source files. See the Flymake's Info manual for more details.
1641
1642 +++
1643 ** The new keypad setup package provides several common bindings for
1644 the numeric keypad which is available on most keyboards. The numeric
1645 keypad typically has the digits 0 to 9, a decimal point, keys marked
1646 +, -, /, and *, an Enter key, and a NumLock toggle key. The keypad
1647 package only controls the use of the digit and decimal keys.
1648
1649 By customizing the variables `keypad-setup', `keypad-shifted-setup',
1650 `keypad-numlock-setup', and `keypad-numlock-shifted-setup', or by
1651 using the function `keypad-setup', you can rebind all digit keys and
1652 the decimal key of the keypad in one step for each of the four
1653 possible combinations of the Shift key state (not pressed/pressed) and
1654 the NumLock toggle state (off/on).
1655
1656 The choices for the keypad keys in each of the above states are:
1657 `Plain numeric keypad' where the keys generates plain digits,
1658 `Numeric keypad with decimal key' where the character produced by the
1659 decimal key can be customized individually (for internationalization),
1660 `Numeric Prefix Arg' where the keypad keys produce numeric prefix args
1661 for emacs editing commands, `Cursor keys' and `Shifted Cursor keys'
1662 where the keys work like (shifted) arrow keys, home/end, etc., and
1663 `Unspecified/User-defined' where the keypad keys (kp-0, kp-1, etc.)
1664 are left unspecified and can be bound individually through the global
1665 or local keymaps.
1666
1667 +++
1668 ** The new kmacro package provides a simpler user interface to
1669 emacs' keyboard macro facilities.
1670
1671 Basically, it uses two function keys (default F3 and F4) like this:
1672 F3 starts a macro, F4 ends the macro, and pressing F4 again executes
1673 the last macro. While defining the macro, F3 inserts a counter value
1674 which automatically increments every time the macro is executed.
1675
1676 There is now a keyboard macro ring which stores the most recently
1677 defined macros.
1678
1679 The C-x C-k sequence is now a prefix for the kmacro keymap which
1680 defines bindings for moving through the keyboard macro ring,
1681 C-x C-k C-p and C-x C-k C-n, editing the last macro C-x C-k C-e,
1682 manipulating the macro counter and format via C-x C-k C-c,
1683 C-x C-k C-a, and C-x C-k C-f. See the commentary in kmacro.el
1684 for more commands.
1685
1686 The normal macro bindings C-x (, C-x ), and C-x e now interfaces to
1687 the keyboard macro ring.
1688
1689 The C-x e command now automatically terminates the current macro
1690 before calling it, if used while defining a macro.
1691
1692 In addition, when ending or calling a macro with C-x e, the macro can
1693 be repeated immediately by typing just the `e'. You can customize
1694 this behavior via the variable kmacro-call-repeat-key and
1695 kmacro-call-repeat-with-arg.
1696
1697 Keyboard macros can now be debugged and edited interactively.
1698 C-x C-k SPC steps through the last keyboard macro one key sequence
1699 at a time, prompting for the actions to take.
1700
1701 ---
1702 ** New minor mode, Visible mode, toggles invisibility in the current buffer.
1703 When enabled, it makes all invisible text visible. When disabled, it
1704 restores the previous value of `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
1705
1706 +++
1707 ** The wdired.el package allows you to use normal editing commands on Dired
1708 buffers to change filenames, permissions, etc...
1709
1710 +++
1711 ** The new package longlines.el provides a minor mode for editing text
1712 files composed of long lines, based on the `use-hard-newlines'
1713 mechanism. The long lines are broken up by inserting soft newlines,
1714 which are automatically removed when saving the file to disk or
1715 copying into the kill ring, clipboard, etc. By default, Longlines
1716 mode inserts soft newlines automatically during editing, a behavior
1717 referred to as "soft word wrap" in other text editors. This is
1718 similar to Refill mode, but more reliable. To turn the word wrap
1719 feature off, set `longlines-auto-wrap' to nil.
1720
1721 +++
1722 ** The printing package is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1723
1724 If you enable the printing package by including (require 'printing) in
1725 the .emacs file, the normal Print item on the File menu is replaced
1726 with a Print sub-menu which allows you to preview output through
1727 ghostview, use ghostscript to print (if you don't have a PostScript
1728 printer) or send directly to printer a PostScript code generated by
1729 `ps-print' package. Use M-x pr-help for more information.
1730
1731 ---
1732 ** The minor mode Reveal mode makes text visible on the fly as you
1733 move your cursor into hidden regions of the buffer.
1734 It should work with any package that uses overlays to hide parts
1735 of a buffer, such as outline-minor-mode, hs-minor-mode, hide-ifdef-mode, ...
1736
1737 There is also Global Reveal mode which affects all buffers.
1738
1739 ---
1740 ** The ruler-mode.el library provides a minor mode for displaying an
1741 "active" ruler in the header line. You can use the mouse to visually
1742 change the `fill-column', `window-margins' and `tab-stop-list'
1743 settings.
1744
1745 +++
1746 ** SES mode (ses-mode) is a new major mode for creating and editing
1747 spreadsheet files. Besides the usual Emacs features (intuitive command
1748 letters, undo, cell formulas in Lisp, plaintext files, etc.) it also offers
1749 viral immunity and import/export of tab-separated values.
1750
1751 +++
1752 ** The new global minor mode `size-indication-mode' (off by default)
1753 shows the size of accessible part of the buffer on the mode line.
1754
1755 +++
1756 ** The new package table.el implements editable, WYSIWYG, embedded
1757 `text tables' in Emacs buffers. It simulates the effect of putting
1758 these tables in a special major mode. The package emulates WYSIWYG
1759 table editing available in modern word processors. The package also
1760 can generate a table source in typesetting and markup languages such
1761 as latex and html from the visually laid out text table.
1762
1763 +++
1764 ** The thumbs.el package allows you to preview image files as thumbnails
1765 and can be invoked from a Dired buffer.
1766
1767 +++
1768 ** Tramp is now part of the distribution.
1769
1770 This package is similar to Ange-FTP: it allows you to edit remote
1771 files. But whereas Ange-FTP uses FTP to access the remote host,
1772 Tramp uses a shell connection. The shell connection is always used
1773 for filename completion and directory listings and suchlike, but for
1774 the actual file transfer, you can choose between the so-called
1775 `inline' methods (which transfer the files through the shell
1776 connection using base64 or uu encoding) and the `out-of-band' methods
1777 (which invoke an external copying program such as `rcp' or `scp' or
1778 `rsync' to do the copying).
1779
1780 Shell connections can be acquired via `rsh', `ssh', `telnet' and also
1781 `su' and `sudo'. Ange-FTP is still supported via the `ftp' method.
1782
1783 If you want to disable Tramp you should set
1784
1785 (setq tramp-default-method "ftp")
1786
1787 ---
1788 ** The URL package (which had been part of W3) is now part of Emacs.
1789
1790 ---
1791 ** `cfengine-mode' is a major mode for editing GNU Cfengine
1792 configuration files.
1793
1794 +++
1795 ** The new package conf-mode.el handles thousands of configuration files, with
1796 varying syntaxes for comments (;, #, //, /* */ or !), assignment (var = value,
1797 var : value, var value or keyword var value) and sections ([section] or
1798 section { }). Many files under /etc/, or with suffixes like .cf through
1799 .config, .properties (Java), .desktop (KDE/Gnome), .ini and many others are
1800 recognized.
1801
1802 ---
1803 ** GDB-Script-mode is used for files like .gdbinit.
1804
1805 +++
1806 ** The new python.el package is used to edit Python and Jython programs.
1807
1808 ---
1809 ** The TCL package tcl-mode.el was replaced by tcl.el.
1810 This was actually done in Emacs-21.1, and was not documented.
1811 \f
1812 * Changes in Specialized Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1:
1813
1814 ---
1815 ** Makefile mode has submodes for automake, gmake, makepp and BSD make.
1816
1817 The former two couldn't be differentiated before, and the latter two
1818 are new. Font-locking is robust now and offers new customizable
1819 faces.
1820
1821 +++
1822 ** In Outline mode, `hide-body' no longer hides lines at the top
1823 of the file that precede the first header line.
1824
1825 +++
1826 ** Telnet now prompts you for a port number with C-u M-x telnet.
1827
1828 ---
1829 ** The terminal emulation code in term.el has been improved; it can
1830 run most curses applications now.
1831
1832 +++
1833 ** M-x diff uses Diff mode instead of Compilation mode.
1834
1835 +++
1836 ** You can now customize `fill-nobreak-predicate' to control where
1837 filling can break lines. The value is now normally a list of
1838 functions, but it can also be a single function, for compatibility.
1839
1840 Emacs provide two predicates, `fill-single-word-nobreak-p' and
1841 `fill-french-nobreak-p', for use as the value of
1842 `fill-nobreak-predicate'.
1843
1844 ---
1845 ** M-x view-file and commands that use it now avoid interfering
1846 with special modes such as Tar mode.
1847
1848 ---
1849 ** Commands `winner-redo' and `winner-undo', from winner.el, are now
1850 bound to C-c <left> and C-c <right>, respectively. This is an
1851 incompatible change.
1852
1853 ---
1854 ** `global-whitespace-mode' is a new alias for `whitespace-global-mode'.
1855
1856 +++
1857 ** M-x compare-windows now can automatically skip non-matching text to
1858 resync points in both windows.
1859
1860 +++
1861 ** New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
1862
1863 When this option is enabled, M-x add-change-log-entry always
1864 starts a new record regardless of when the last record is.
1865
1866 ---
1867 ** PO translation files are decoded according to their MIME headers
1868 when Emacs visits them.
1869
1870 ** Info mode changes:
1871
1872 +++
1873 *** A numeric prefix argument of `info' selects an Info buffer
1874 with the number appended to the `*info*' buffer name (e.g. "*info*<2>").
1875
1876 ---
1877 *** isearch in Info uses Info-search and searches through multiple nodes.
1878
1879 Before leaving the initial Info node isearch fails once with the error
1880 message [initial node], and with subsequent C-s/C-r continues through
1881 other nodes. When isearch fails for the rest of the manual, it wraps
1882 aroung the whole manual to the top/final node. The user option
1883 `Info-isearch-search' controls whether to use Info-search for isearch,
1884 or the default isearch search function that wraps around the current
1885 Info node.
1886
1887 *** New search commands: `Info-search-case-sensitively' (bound to S),
1888 `Info-search-backward', and `Info-search-next' which repeats the last
1889 search without prompting for a new search string.
1890
1891 *** New command `Info-history-forward' (bound to r and new toolbar icon)
1892 moves forward in history to the node you returned from after using
1893 `Info-history-back' (renamed from `Info-last').
1894
1895 *** New command `Info-history' (bound to L) displays a menu of visited nodes.
1896
1897 *** New command `Info-toc' (bound to T) creates a node with table of contents
1898 from the tree structure of menus of the current Info file.
1899
1900 *** New command `info-apropos' searches the indices of the known
1901 Info files on your system for a string, and builds a menu of the
1902 possible matches.
1903
1904 *** New command `Info-copy-current-node-name' (bound to w) copies
1905 the current Info node name into the kill ring. With a zero prefix
1906 arg, puts the node name inside the `info' function call.
1907
1908 ---
1909 *** New face `info-xref-visited' distinguishes visited nodes from unvisited
1910 and a new option `Info-fontify-visited-nodes' to control this.
1911
1912 *** http and ftp links in Info are now operational: they look like cross
1913 references and following them calls `browse-url'.
1914
1915 +++
1916 *** Info now hides node names in menus and cross references by default.
1917
1918 If you prefer the old behavior, you can set the new user option
1919 `Info-hide-note-references' to nil.
1920
1921 ---
1922 *** Images in Info pages are supported.
1923
1924 Info pages show embedded images, in Emacs frames with image support.
1925 Info documentation that includes images, processed with makeinfo
1926 version 4.7 or newer, compiles to Info pages with embedded images.
1927
1928 +++
1929 *** The default value for `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' is now nil.
1930
1931 ---
1932 *** `Info-index' offers completion.
1933
1934 ** Lisp mode changes:
1935
1936 ---
1937 *** Lisp mode now uses `font-lock-doc-face' for doc strings.
1938
1939 +++
1940 *** C-u C-M-q in Emacs Lisp mode pretty-prints the list after point.
1941
1942 *** New features in evaluation commands
1943
1944 +++
1945 **** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) called on defface reinitializes
1946 the face to the value specified in the defface expression.
1947
1948 +++
1949 **** Typing C-x C-e twice prints the value of the integer result
1950 in additional formats (octal, hexadecimal, character) specified
1951 by the new function `eval-expression-print-format'. The same
1952 function also defines the result format for `eval-expression' (M-:),
1953 `eval-print-last-sexp' (C-j) and some edebug evaluation functions.
1954
1955 +++
1956 ** CC mode changes.
1957
1958 *** Font lock support.
1959 CC Mode now provides font lock support for all its languages. This
1960 supersedes the font lock patterns that have been in the core font lock
1961 package for C, C++, Java and Objective-C. Like indentation, font
1962 locking is done in a uniform way across all languages (except the new
1963 AWK mode - see below). That means that the new font locking will be
1964 different from the old patterns in various details for most languages.
1965
1966 The main goal of the font locking in CC Mode is accuracy, to provide a
1967 dependable aid in recognizing the various constructs. Some, like
1968 strings and comments, are easy to recognize while others like
1969 declarations and types can be very tricky. CC Mode can go to great
1970 lengths to recognize declarations and casts correctly, especially when
1971 the types aren't recognized by standard patterns. This is a fairly
1972 demanding analysis which can be slow on older hardware, and it can
1973 therefore be disabled by choosing a lower decoration level with the
1974 variable font-lock-maximum-decoration.
1975
1976 Note that the most demanding font lock level has been tuned with lazy
1977 fontification in mind, i.e. there should be a support mode that waits
1978 with the fontification until the text is actually shown
1979 (e.g. Just-in-time Lock mode, which is the default, or Lazy Lock
1980 mode). Fontifying a file with several thousand lines in one go can
1981 take the better part of a minute.
1982
1983 **** The (c|c++|objc|java|idl|pike)-font-lock-extra-types variables
1984 are now used by CC Mode to recognize identifiers that are certain to
1985 be types. (They are also used in cases that aren't related to font
1986 locking.) At the maximum decoration level, types are often recognized
1987 properly anyway, so these variables should be fairly restrictive and
1988 not contain patterns for uncertain types.
1989
1990 **** Support for documentation comments.
1991 There is a "plugin" system to fontify documentation comments like
1992 Javadoc and the markup within them. It's independent of the host
1993 language, so it's possible to e.g. turn on Javadoc font locking in C
1994 buffers. See the variable c-doc-comment-style for details.
1995
1996 Currently two kinds of doc comment styles are recognized: Suns Javadoc
1997 and Autodoc which is used in Pike. This is by no means a complete
1998 list of the most common tools; if your doc comment extractor of choice
1999 is missing then please drop a note to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2000
2001 **** Better handling of C++ templates.
2002 As a side effect of the more accurate font locking, C++ templates are
2003 now handled much better. The angle brackets that delimit them are
2004 given parenthesis syntax so that they can be navigated like other
2005 parens.
2006
2007 This also improves indentation of templates, although there still is
2008 work to be done in that area. E.g. it's required that multiline
2009 template clauses are written in full and then refontified to be
2010 recognized, and the indentation of nested templates is a bit odd and
2011 not as configurable as it ought to be.
2012
2013 **** Improved handling of Objective-C and CORBA IDL.
2014 Especially the support for Objective-C and IDL has gotten an overhaul.
2015 The special "@" declarations in Objective-C are handled correctly.
2016 All the keywords used in CORBA IDL, PSDL, and CIDL are recognized and
2017 handled correctly, also wrt indentation.
2018
2019 *** Support for the AWK language.
2020 Support for the AWK language has been introduced. The implementation is
2021 based around GNU AWK version 3.1, but it should work pretty well with
2022 any AWK. As yet, not all features of CC Mode have been adapted for AWK.
2023 Here is a summary:
2024
2025 **** Indentation Engine
2026 The CC Mode indentation engine fully supports AWK mode.
2027
2028 AWK mode handles code formatted in the conventional AWK fashion: `{'s
2029 which start actions, user-defined functions, or compound statements are
2030 placed on the same line as the associated construct; the matching `}'s
2031 are normally placed under the start of the respective pattern, function
2032 definition, or structured statement.
2033
2034 The predefined indentation functions haven't yet been adapted for AWK
2035 mode, though some of them may work serendipitously. There shouldn't be
2036 any problems writing custom indentation functions for AWK mode.
2037
2038 The command C-c C-q (c-indent-defun) hasn't yet been adapted for AWK,
2039 though in practice it works properly nearly all the time. Should it
2040 fail, explicitly set the region around the function (using C-u C-SPC:
2041 C-M-h probably won't work either) then do C-M-\ (indent-region).
2042
2043 **** Font Locking
2044 There is a single level of font locking in AWK mode, rather than the
2045 three distinct levels the other modes have. There are several
2046 idiosyncrasies in AWK mode's font-locking due to the peculiarities of
2047 the AWK language itself.
2048
2049 **** Comment Commands
2050 M-; (indent-for-comment) works fine. None of the other CC Mode
2051 comment formatting commands have yet been adapted for AWK mode.
2052
2053 **** Movement Commands
2054 Most of the movement commands work in AWK mode. The most important
2055 exceptions are M-a (c-beginning-of-statement) and M-e
2056 (c-end-of-statement) which haven't yet been adapted.
2057
2058 The notion of "defun" has been augmented to include AWK pattern-action
2059 pairs. C-M-a (c-awk-beginning-of-defun) and C-M-e (c-awk-end-of-defun)
2060 recognise these pattern-action pairs, as well as user defined
2061 functions.
2062
2063 **** Auto-newline Insertion and Clean-ups
2064 Auto-newline insertion hasn't yet been adapted for AWK. Some of
2065 the clean-ups can actually convert good AWK code into syntactically
2066 invalid code. These features are best disabled in AWK buffers.
2067
2068 *** New syntactic symbols in IDL mode.
2069 The top level constructs "module" and "composition" (from CIDL) are
2070 now handled like "namespace" in C++: They are given syntactic symbols
2071 module-open, module-close, inmodule, composition-open,
2072 composition-close, and incomposition.
2073
2074 *** New functions to do hungry delete without enabling hungry delete mode.
2075 The functions `c-hungry-backspace' and `c-hungry-delete-forward' can be
2076 bound to keys to get this feature without toggling a mode.
2077
2078 *** Better control over `require-final-newline'.
2079
2080 The variable `c-require-final-newline' specifies which of the modes
2081 implemented by CC mode should insert final newlines. Its value is a
2082 list of modes, and only those modes should do it. By default the list
2083 includes C, C++ and Objective-C modes.
2084
2085 Whichever modes are in this list will set `require-final-newline'
2086 based on `mode-require-final-newline'.
2087
2088 *** Format change for syntactic context elements.
2089
2090 The elements in the syntactic context returned by `c-guess-basic-syntax'
2091 and stored in `c-syntactic-context' has been changed somewhat to allow
2092 attaching more information. They are now lists instead of single cons
2093 cells. E.g. a line that previously had the syntactic analysis
2094
2095 ((inclass . 11) (topmost-intro . 13))
2096
2097 is now analysed as
2098
2099 ((inclass 11) (topmost-intro 13))
2100
2101 In some cases there are more than one position given for a syntactic
2102 symbol.
2103
2104 This change might affect code that call `c-guess-basic-syntax' directly,
2105 and custom lineup functions if they use `c-syntactic-context'. However,
2106 the argument given to lineup functions is still a single cons cell
2107 with nil or an integer in the cdr.
2108
2109 *** API changes for derived modes.
2110
2111 There have been extensive changes "under the hood" which can affect
2112 derived mode writers. Some of these changes are likely to cause
2113 incompatibilities with existing derived modes, but on the other hand
2114 care has now been taken to make it possible to extend and modify CC
2115 Mode with less risk of such problems in the future.
2116
2117 **** New language variable system.
2118 See the comment blurb near the top of cc-langs.el.
2119
2120 **** New initialization functions.
2121 The initialization procedure has been split up into more functions to
2122 give better control: `c-basic-common-init', `c-font-lock-init', and
2123 `c-init-language-vars'.
2124
2125 *** Changes in analysis of nested syntactic constructs.
2126 The syntactic analysis engine has better handling of cases where
2127 several syntactic constructs appear nested on the same line. They are
2128 now handled as if each construct started on a line of its own.
2129
2130 This means that CC Mode now indents some cases differently, and
2131 although it's more consistent there might be cases where the old way
2132 gave results that's more to one's liking. So if you find a situation
2133 where you think that the indentation has become worse, please report
2134 it to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2135
2136 **** New syntactic symbol substatement-label.
2137 This symbol is used when a label is inserted between a statement and
2138 its substatement. E.g:
2139
2140 if (x)
2141 x_is_true:
2142 do_stuff();
2143
2144 *** Better handling of multiline macros.
2145
2146 **** Syntactic indentation inside macros.
2147 The contents of multiline #define's are now analyzed and indented
2148 syntactically just like other code. This can be disabled by the new
2149 variable `c-syntactic-indentation-in-macros'. A new syntactic symbol
2150 `cpp-define-intro' has been added to control the initial indentation
2151 inside `#define's.
2152
2153 **** New lineup function `c-lineup-cpp-define'.
2154
2155 Now used by default to line up macro continuation lines. The behavior
2156 of this function closely mimics the indentation one gets if the macro
2157 is indented while the line continuation backslashes are temporarily
2158 removed. If syntactic indentation in macros is turned off, it works
2159 much line `c-lineup-dont-change', which was used earlier, but handles
2160 empty lines within the macro better.
2161
2162 **** Automatically inserted newlines continues the macro if used within one.
2163 This applies to the newlines inserted by the auto-newline mode, and to
2164 `c-context-line-break' and `c-context-open-line'.
2165
2166 **** Better alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2167 `c-backslash-region' tries to adapt to surrounding backslashes. New
2168 variable `c-backslash-max-column' which put a limit on how far out
2169 backslashes can be moved.
2170
2171 **** Automatic alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2172 This is controlled by the new variable `c-auto-align-backslashes'. It
2173 affects `c-context-line-break', `c-context-open-line' and newlines
2174 inserted in Auto-Newline mode.
2175 **** Line indentation works better inside macros.
2176
2177 Regardless whether syntactic indentation and syntactic indentation
2178 inside macros are enabled or not, line indentation now ignores the
2179 line continuation backslashes. This is most noticeable when syntactic
2180 indentation is turned off and there are empty lines (save for the
2181 backslash) in the macro.
2182
2183 *** indent-for-comment is more customizable.
2184 The behavior of M-; (indent-for-comment) is now configurable through
2185 the variable `c-indent-comment-alist'. The indentation behavior based
2186 on the preceding code on the line, e.g. to get two spaces after #else
2187 and #endif but indentation to `comment-column' in most other cases
2188 (something which was hardcoded earlier).
2189
2190 *** New function `c-context-open-line'.
2191 It's the open-line equivalent of `c-context-line-break'.
2192
2193 *** New lineup functions
2194
2195 **** `c-lineup-string-cont'
2196 This lineup function lines up a continued string under the one it
2197 continues. E.g:
2198
2199 result = prefix + "A message "
2200 "string."; <- c-lineup-string-cont
2201
2202 **** `c-lineup-cascaded-calls'
2203 Lines up series of calls separated by "->" or ".".
2204
2205 **** `c-lineup-knr-region-comment'
2206 Gives (what most people think is) better indentation of comments in
2207 the "K&R region" between the function header and its body.
2208
2209 **** `c-lineup-gcc-asm-reg'
2210 Provides better indentation inside asm blocks.
2211
2212 **** `c-lineup-argcont'
2213 Lines up continued function arguments after the preceding comma.
2214
2215 *** Better caching of the syntactic context.
2216 CC Mode caches the positions of the opening parentheses (of any kind)
2217 of the lists surrounding the point. Those positions are used in many
2218 places as anchor points for various searches. The cache is now
2219 improved so that it can be reused to a large extent when the point is
2220 moved. The less it moves, the less needs to be recalculated.
2221
2222 The effect is that CC Mode should be fast most of the time even when
2223 opening parens are hung (i.e. aren't in column zero). It's typically
2224 only the first time after the point is moved far down in a complex
2225 file that it'll take noticeable time to find out the syntactic
2226 context.
2227
2228 *** Statements are recognized in a more robust way.
2229 Statements are recognized most of the time even when they occur in an
2230 "invalid" context, e.g. in a function argument. In practice that can
2231 happen when macros are involved.
2232
2233 *** Improved the way `c-indent-exp' chooses the block to indent.
2234 It now indents the block for the closest sexp following the point
2235 whose closing paren ends on a different line. This means that the
2236 point doesn't have to be immediately before the block to indent.
2237 Also, only the block and the closing line is indented; the current
2238 line is left untouched.
2239
2240 *** Added toggle for syntactic indentation.
2241 The function `c-toggle-syntactic-indentation' can be used to toggle
2242 syntactic indentation.
2243
2244 ---
2245 ** Perl mode has a new variable `perl-indent-continued-arguments'.
2246
2247 ---
2248 ** The old Octave mode bindings C-c f and C-c i have been changed
2249 to C-c C-f and C-c C-i. The C-c C-i subcommands now have duplicate
2250 bindings on control characters--thus, C-c C-i C-b is the same as
2251 C-c C-i b, and so on.
2252
2253 ** Fortran mode changes:
2254
2255 ---
2256 *** Fortran mode does more font-locking by default. Use level 3
2257 highlighting for the old default.
2258
2259 +++
2260 *** Fortran mode has a new variable `fortran-directive-re'.
2261 Adapt this to match the format of any compiler directives you use.
2262 Lines that match are never indented, and are given distinctive font-locking.
2263
2264 +++
2265 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have new navigation commands
2266 `f90-end-of-block', `f90-beginning-of-block', `f90-next-block',
2267 `f90-previous-block', `fortran-end-of-block',
2268 `fortran-beginning-of-block'.
2269
2270 ---
2271 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have support for `hs-minor-mode' (hideshow).
2272 It cannot deal with every code format, but ought to handle a sizeable
2273 majority.
2274
2275 ---
2276 *** The new function `f90-backslash-not-special' can be used to change
2277 the syntax of backslashes in F90 buffers.
2278
2279 ---
2280 ** Prolog mode has a new variable `prolog-font-lock-keywords'
2281 to support use of font-lock.
2282
2283 ** HTML/SGML changes:
2284
2285 ---
2286 *** Emacs now tries to set up buffer coding systems for HTML/XML files
2287 automatically.
2288
2289 +++
2290 *** SGML mode has indentation and supports XML syntax.
2291 The new variable `sgml-xml-mode' tells SGML mode to use XML syntax.
2292 When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
2293 i.e., there is always a closing tag.
2294 By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
2295 from the file name or buffer contents.
2296
2297 +++
2298 *** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
2299
2300 ** TeX modes:
2301
2302 +++
2303 *** C-c C-c prompts for a command to run, and tries to offer a good default.
2304
2305 +++
2306 *** The user option `tex-start-options-string' has been replaced
2307 by two new user options: `tex-start-options', which should hold
2308 command-line options to feed to TeX, and `tex-start-commands' which should hold
2309 TeX commands to use at startup.
2310
2311 ---
2312 *** verbatim environments are now highlighted in courier by font-lock
2313 and super/sub-scripts are made into super/sub-scripts.
2314
2315 +++
2316 *** New major mode Doctex mode, for *.dtx files.
2317
2318 ** BibTeX mode:
2319
2320 *** The new command `bibtex-url' browses a URL for the BibTeX entry at
2321 point (bound to C-c C-l and mouse-2, RET on clickable fields).
2322
2323 *** The new command `bibtex-entry-update' (bound to C-c C-u) updates
2324 an existing BibTeX entry.
2325
2326 *** New `bibtex-entry-format' option `required-fields', enabled by default.
2327
2328 *** `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' can take values `plain',
2329 `crossref', and `entry-class' which control the sorting scheme used
2330 for BibTeX entries. `bibtex-sort-entry-class' controls the sorting
2331 scheme `entry-class'. TAB completion for reference keys and
2332 automatic detection of duplicates does not require anymore that
2333 `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' is non-nil.
2334
2335 *** If the new variable `bibtex-parse-keys-fast' is non-nil,
2336 use fast but simplified algorithm for parsing BibTeX keys.
2337
2338 *** If the new variable `bibtex-autoadd-commas' is non-nil,
2339 automatically add missing commas at end of BibTeX fields.
2340
2341 *** The new variable `bibtex-autofill-types' contains a list of entry
2342 types for which fields are filled automatically (if possible).
2343
2344 *** The new command `bibtex-complete' completes word fragment before
2345 point according to context (bound to M-tab).
2346
2347 *** The new commands `bibtex-find-entry' and `bibtex-find-crossref'
2348 locate entries and crossref'd entries (bound to C-c C-s and C-c C-x).
2349 Crossref fields are clickable (bound to mouse-2, RET).
2350
2351 *** In BibTeX mode the command `fill-paragraph' (M-q) fills
2352 individual fields of a BibTeX entry.
2353
2354 *** The new variables `bibtex-files' and `bibtex-file-path' define a set
2355 of BibTeX files that are searched for entry keys.
2356
2357 *** The new command `bibtex-validate-globally' checks for duplicate keys
2358 in multiple BibTeX files.
2359
2360 *** The new command `bibtex-copy-summary-as-kill' pushes summary
2361 of BibTeX entry to kill ring (bound to C-c C-t).
2362
2363 +++
2364 ** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now
2365 by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l'
2366 and `C-c C-r'.
2367
2368 ** GUD changes:
2369
2370 +++
2371 *** In GUD mode, when talking to GDB, C-x C-a C-j "jumps" the program
2372 counter to the specified source line (the one where point is).
2373
2374 ---
2375 *** GUD mode has its own tool bar for controlling execution of the inferior
2376 and other common debugger commands.
2377
2378 +++
2379 *** The new package gdb-ui.el provides an enhanced graphical interface to
2380 GDB. You can interact with GDB through the GUD buffer in the usual way, but
2381 there are also further buffers which control the execution and describe the
2382 state of your program. It can separate the input/output of your program from
2383 that of GDB and watches expressions in the speedbar. It also uses features of
2384 Emacs 21/22 such as the the toolbar, and bitmaps in the fringe to indicate
2385 breakpoints.
2386
2387 Use M-x gdb to start GDB-UI.
2388
2389 *** The variable tooltip-gud-tips-p has been removed. GUD tooltips can now be
2390 toggled independently of normal tooltips with the minor mode
2391 `gud-tooltip-mode'.
2392
2393 +++
2394 *** In graphical mode, with a C program, GUD Tooltips have been extended to
2395 display the #define directive associated with an identifier when program is
2396 not executing.
2397
2398 ---
2399 ** GUD mode improvements for jdb:
2400
2401 *** Search for source files using jdb classpath and class
2402 information. Fast startup since there is no need to scan all
2403 source files up front. There is also no need to create and maintain
2404 lists of source directories to scan. Look at `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
2405 and `gud-jdb-classpath' customization variables documentation.
2406
2407 *** Supports the standard breakpoint (gud-break, gud-clear)
2408 set/clear operations from java source files under the classpath, stack
2409 traversal (gud-up, gud-down), and run until current stack finish
2410 (gud-finish).
2411
2412 *** Supports new jdb (Java 1.2 and later) in addition to oldjdb
2413 (Java 1.1 jdb).
2414
2415 *** The previous method of searching for source files has been
2416 preserved in case someone still wants/needs to use it.
2417 Set `gud-jdb-use-classpath' to nil.
2418
2419 Added Customization Variables
2420
2421 *** `gud-jdb-command-name'. What command line to use to invoke jdb.
2422
2423 *** `gud-jdb-use-classpath'. Allows selection of java source file searching
2424 method: set to t for new method, nil to scan `gud-jdb-directories' for
2425 java sources (previous method).
2426
2427 *** `gud-jdb-directories'. List of directories to scan and search for java
2428 classes using the original gud-jdb method (if `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
2429 is nil).
2430
2431 Minor Improvements
2432
2433 *** The STARTTLS wrapper (starttls.el) can now use GNUTLS
2434 instead of the OpenSSL based `starttls' tool. For backwards
2435 compatibility, it prefers `starttls', but you can toggle
2436 `starttls-use-gnutls' to switch to GNUTLS (or simply remove the
2437 `starttls' tool).
2438
2439 *** Do not allow debugger output history variable to grow without bounds.
2440
2441 ** Auto-Revert changes:
2442
2443 +++
2444 *** You can now use Auto Revert mode to `tail' a file.
2445
2446 If point is at the end of a file buffer before reverting, Auto Revert
2447 mode keeps it at the end after reverting. Similarly if point is
2448 displayed at the end of a file buffer in any window, it stays at
2449 the end of the buffer in that window. This allows to tail a file:
2450 just put point at the end of the buffer and it stays there. This
2451 rule applies to file buffers. For non-file buffers, the behavior can
2452 be mode dependent.
2453
2454 If you are sure that the file will only change by growing at the end,
2455 then you can tail the file more efficiently by using the new minor
2456 mode Auto Revert Tail mode. The function `auto-revert-tail-mode'
2457 toggles this mode.
2458
2459 +++
2460 *** Auto Revert mode is now more careful to avoid excessive reverts and
2461 other potential problems when deciding which non-file buffers to
2462 revert. This matters especially if Global Auto Revert mode is enabled
2463 and `global-auto-revert-non-file-buffers' is non-nil. Auto Revert
2464 mode only reverts a non-file buffer if the buffer has a non-nil
2465 `revert-buffer-function' and a non-nil `buffer-stale-function', which
2466 decides whether the buffer should be reverted. Currently, this means
2467 that auto reverting works for Dired buffers (although this may not
2468 work properly on all operating systems) and for the Buffer Menu.
2469
2470 +++
2471 *** If the new user option `auto-revert-check-vc-info' is non-nil, Auto
2472 Revert mode reliably updates version control info (such as the version
2473 control number in the mode line), in all version controlled buffers in
2474 which it is active. If the option is nil, the default, then this info
2475 only gets updated whenever the buffer gets reverted.
2476
2477 ---
2478 ** recentf changes.
2479
2480 The recent file list is now automatically cleanup when recentf mode is
2481 enabled. The new option `recentf-auto-cleanup' controls when to do
2482 automatic cleanup.
2483
2484 The `recentf-keep' option replaces `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-p'
2485 and provides a more general mechanism to customize which file names to
2486 keep in the recent list.
2487
2488 With the more advanced option: `recentf-filename-handler', you can
2489 specify a function that transforms filenames handled by recentf. For
2490 example, if set to `file-truename', the same file will not be in the
2491 recent list with different symbolic links.
2492
2493 To follow naming convention, `recentf-menu-append-commands-flag'
2494 replaces the misnamed option `recentf-menu-append-commands-p'. The
2495 old name remains available as alias, but has been marked obsolete.
2496
2497 +++
2498 ** Desktop package
2499
2500 +++
2501 *** Desktop saving is now a minor mode, `desktop-save-mode'.
2502
2503 +++
2504 *** The variable `desktop-enable' is obsolete.
2505
2506 Customize `desktop-save-mode' to enable desktop saving.
2507
2508 ---
2509 *** Buffers are saved in the desktop file in the same order as that in the
2510 buffer list.
2511
2512 +++
2513 *** The desktop package can be customized to restore only some buffers
2514 immediately, remaining buffers are restored lazily (when Emacs is
2515 idle).
2516
2517 +++
2518 *** New commands:
2519 - desktop-revert reverts to the last loaded desktop.
2520 - desktop-change-dir kills current desktop and loads a new.
2521 - desktop-save-in-desktop-dir saves desktop in the directory from which
2522 it was loaded.
2523 - desktop-lazy-complete runs the desktop load to completion.
2524 - desktop-lazy-abort aborts lazy loading of the desktop.
2525
2526 ---
2527 *** New customizable variables:
2528 - desktop-save. Determins whether the desktop should be saved when it is
2529 killed.
2530 - desktop-file-name-format. Format in which desktop file names should be saved.
2531 - desktop-path. List of directories in which to lookup the desktop file.
2532 - desktop-locals-to-save. List of local variables to save.
2533 - desktop-globals-to-clear. List of global variables that `desktop-clear' will clear.
2534 - desktop-clear-preserve-buffers-regexp. Regexp identifying buffers that `desktop-clear'
2535 should not delete.
2536 - desktop-restore-eager. Number of buffers to restore immediately. Remaining buffers are
2537 restored lazily (when Emacs is idle).
2538 - desktop-lazy-verbose. Verbose reporting of lazily created buffers.
2539 - desktop-lazy-idle-delay. Idle delay before starting to create buffers.
2540
2541 +++
2542 *** New command line option --no-desktop
2543
2544 ---
2545 *** New hooks:
2546 - desktop-after-read-hook run after a desktop is loaded.
2547 - desktop-no-desktop-file-hook run when no desktop file is found.
2548
2549 ---
2550 ** The saveplace.el package now filters out unreadable files.
2551
2552 When you exit Emacs, the saved positions in visited files no longer
2553 include files that aren't readable, e.g. files that don't exist.
2554 Customize the new option `save-place-forget-unreadable-files' to nil
2555 to get the old behavior. The new options `save-place-save-skipped'
2556 and `save-place-skip-check-regexp' allow further fine-tuning of this
2557 feature.
2558
2559 ** EDiff changes.
2560
2561 +++
2562 *** When comparing directories.
2563 Typing D brings up a buffer that lists the differences between the contents of
2564 directories. Now it is possible to use this buffer to copy the missing files
2565 from one directory to another.
2566
2567 +++
2568 *** When comparing files or buffers.
2569 Typing the = key now offers to perform the word-by-word comparison of the
2570 currently highlighted regions in an inferior Ediff session. If you answer 'n'
2571 then it reverts to the old behavior and asks the user to select regions for
2572 comparison.
2573
2574 +++
2575 *** The new command `ediff-backup' compares a file with its most recent
2576 backup using `ediff'. If you specify the name of a backup file,
2577 `ediff-backup' compares it with the file of which it is a backup.
2578
2579 +++
2580 ** Etags changes.
2581
2582 *** New regular expressions features
2583
2584 **** New syntax for regular expressions, multi-line regular expressions.
2585
2586 The syntax --ignore-case-regexp=/regex/ is now undocumented and retained
2587 only for backward compatibility. The new equivalent syntax is
2588 --regex=/regex/i. More generally, it is --regex=/TAGREGEX/TAGNAME/MODS,
2589 where `/TAGNAME' is optional, as usual, and MODS is a string of 0 or
2590 more characters among `i' (ignore case), `m' (multi-line) and `s'
2591 (single-line). The `m' and `s' modifiers behave as in Perl regular
2592 expressions: `m' allows regexps to match more than one line, while `s'
2593 (which implies `m') means that `.' matches newlines. The ability to
2594 span newlines allows writing of much more powerful regular expressions
2595 and rapid prototyping for tagging new languages.
2596
2597 **** Regular expressions can use char escape sequences as in GCC.
2598
2599 The escaped character sequence \a, \b, \d, \e, \f, \n, \r, \t, \v,
2600 respectively, stand for the ASCII characters BEL, BS, DEL, ESC, FF, NL,
2601 CR, TAB, VT,
2602
2603 **** Regular expressions can be bound to a given language.
2604
2605 The syntax --regex={LANGUAGE}REGEX means that REGEX is used to make tags
2606 only for files of language LANGUAGE, and ignored otherwise. This is
2607 particularly useful when storing regexps in a file.
2608
2609 **** Regular expressions can be read from a file.
2610
2611 The --regex=@regexfile option means read the regexps from a file, one
2612 per line. Lines beginning with space or tab are ignored.
2613
2614 *** New language parsing features
2615
2616 **** The `::' qualifier triggers C++ parsing in C file.
2617
2618 Previously, only the `template' and `class' keywords had this effect.
2619
2620 **** The GCC __attribute__ keyword is now recognised and ignored.
2621
2622 **** New language HTML.
2623
2624 Tags are generated for `title' as well as `h1', `h2', and `h3'. Also,
2625 when `name=' is used inside an anchor and whenever `id=' is used.
2626
2627 **** In Makefiles, constants are tagged.
2628
2629 If you want the old behavior instead, thus avoiding to increase the
2630 size of the tags file, use the --no-globals option.
2631
2632 **** New language Lua.
2633
2634 All functions are tagged.
2635
2636 **** In Perl, packages are tags.
2637
2638 Subroutine tags are named from their package. You can jump to sub tags
2639 as you did before, by the sub name, or additionally by looking for
2640 package::sub.
2641
2642 **** In Prolog, etags creates tags for rules in addition to predicates.
2643
2644 **** New language PHP.
2645
2646 Functions, classes and defines are tags. If the --members option is
2647 specified to etags, variables are tags also.
2648
2649 **** New default keywords for TeX.
2650
2651 The new keywords are def, newcommand, renewcommand, newenvironment and
2652 renewenvironment.
2653
2654 *** Honour #line directives.
2655
2656 When Etags parses an input file that contains C preprocessor's #line
2657 directives, it creates tags using the file name and line number
2658 specified in those directives. This is useful when dealing with code
2659 created from Cweb source files. When Etags tags the generated file, it
2660 writes tags pointing to the source file.
2661
2662 *** New option --parse-stdin=FILE.
2663
2664 This option is mostly useful when calling etags from programs. It can
2665 be used (only once) in place of a file name on the command line. Etags
2666 reads from standard input and marks the produced tags as belonging to
2667 the file FILE.
2668
2669 ** VC Changes
2670
2671 +++
2672 *** The key C-x C-q only changes the read-only state of the buffer
2673 (toggle-read-only). It no longer checks files in or out.
2674
2675 We made this change because we held a poll and found that many users
2676 were unhappy with the previous behavior. If you do prefer this
2677 behavior, you can bind `vc-toggle-read-only' to C-x C-q in your
2678 `.emacs' file:
2679
2680 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-q" 'vc-toggle-read-only)
2681
2682 The function `vc-toggle-read-only' will continue to exist.
2683
2684 +++
2685 *** The new variable `vc-cvs-global-switches' specifies switches that
2686 are passed to any CVS command invoked by VC.
2687
2688 These switches are used as "global options" for CVS, which means they
2689 are inserted before the command name. For example, this allows you to
2690 specify a compression level using the `-z#' option for CVS.
2691
2692 +++
2693 *** New backends for Subversion and Meta-CVS.
2694
2695 +++
2696 *** VC-Annotate mode enhancements
2697
2698 In VC-Annotate mode, you can now use the following key bindings for
2699 enhanced functionality to browse the annotations of past revisions, or
2700 to view diffs or log entries directly from vc-annotate-mode:
2701
2702 P: annotates the previous revision
2703 N: annotates the next revision
2704 J: annotates the revision at line
2705 A: annotates the revision previous to line
2706 D: shows the diff of the revision at line with its previous revision
2707 L: shows the log of the revision at line
2708 W: annotates the workfile (most up to date) version
2709
2710 ** pcl-cvs changes:
2711
2712 +++
2713 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d y' command to view the diffs
2714 between the local version of the file and yesterday's head revision
2715 in the repository.
2716
2717 +++
2718 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d r' command to view the changes
2719 anyone has committed to the repository since you last executed
2720 `checkout', `update' or `commit'. That means using cvs diff options
2721 -rBASE -rHEAD.
2722
2723 +++
2724 ** The new variable `mail-default-directory' specifies
2725 `default-directory' for mail buffers. This directory is used for
2726 auto-save files of mail buffers. It defaults to "~/".
2727
2728 +++
2729 ** The mode line can indicate new mail in a directory or file.
2730
2731 See the documentation of the user option
2732 `display-time-mail-directory'.
2733
2734 ** Rmail changes:
2735
2736 ---
2737 *** Rmail now displays 5-digit message ids in its summary buffer.
2738
2739 +++
2740 *** Support for `movemail' from GNU mailutils was added to Rmail.
2741
2742 This version of `movemail' allows to read mail from a wide range of
2743 mailbox formats, including remote POP3 and IMAP4 mailboxes with or
2744 without TLS encryption. If GNU mailutils is installed on the system
2745 and its version of `movemail' can be found in exec-path, it will be
2746 used instead of the native one.
2747
2748 ** Gnus package
2749
2750 ---
2751 *** Gnus now includes Sieve and PGG
2752
2753 Sieve is a library for managing Sieve scripts. PGG is a library to handle
2754 PGP/MIME.
2755
2756 ---
2757 *** There are many news features, bug fixes and improvements.
2758
2759 See the file GNUS-NEWS or the node "Oort Gnus" in the Gnus manual for details.
2760
2761 ---
2762 ** MH-E changes.
2763
2764 Upgraded to MH-E version 7.84. There have been major changes since
2765 version 5.0.2; see MH-E-NEWS for details.
2766
2767 ** Calendar changes:
2768
2769 +++
2770 *** There is a new calendar package, icalendar.el, that can be used to
2771 convert Emacs diary entries to/from the iCalendar format.
2772
2773 +++
2774 *** Diary sexp entries can have custom marking in the calendar.
2775 Diary sexp functions which only apply to certain days (such as
2776 `diary-block' or `diary-cyclic') now take an optional parameter MARK,
2777 which is the name of a face or a single-character string indicating
2778 how to highlight the day in the calendar display. Specifying a
2779 single-character string as @var{mark} places the character next to the
2780 day in the calendar. Specifying a face highlights the day with that
2781 face. This lets you have different colors or markings for vacations,
2782 appointments, paydays or anything else using a sexp.
2783
2784 +++
2785 *** The new function `calendar-goto-day-of-year' (g D) prompts for a
2786 year and day number, and moves to that date. Negative day numbers
2787 count backward from the end of the year.
2788
2789 +++
2790 *** The new Calendar function `calendar-goto-iso-week' (g w)
2791 prompts for a year and a week number, and moves to the first
2792 day of that ISO week.
2793
2794 ---
2795 *** The new variable `calendar-minimum-window-height' affects the
2796 window generated by the function `generate-calendar-window'.
2797
2798 ---
2799 *** The functions `holiday-easter-etc' and `holiday-advent' now take
2800 optional arguments, in order to only report on the specified holiday
2801 rather than all. This makes customization of variables such as
2802 `christian-holidays' simpler.
2803
2804 ---
2805 *** The function `simple-diary-display' now by default sets a header line.
2806 This can be controlled through the variables `diary-header-line-flag'
2807 and `diary-header-line-format'.
2808
2809 +++
2810 *** The procedure for activating appointment reminders has changed:
2811 use the new function `appt-activate'. The new variable
2812 `appt-display-format' controls how reminders are displayed, replacing
2813 `appt-issue-message', `appt-visible', and `appt-msg-window'.
2814
2815 +++
2816 *** The new functions `diary-from-outlook', `diary-from-outlook-gnus',
2817 and `diary-from-outlook-rmail' can be used to import diary entries
2818 from Outlook-format appointments in mail messages. The variable
2819 `diary-outlook-formats' can be customized to recognize additional
2820 formats.
2821
2822 ---
2823 ** sql changes.
2824
2825 *** The variable `sql-product' controls the highlightng of different
2826 SQL dialects. This variable can be set globally via Customize, on a
2827 buffer-specific basis via local variable settings, or for the current
2828 session using the new SQL->Product submenu. (This menu replaces the
2829 SQL->Highlighting submenu.)
2830
2831 The following values are supported:
2832
2833 ansi ANSI Standard (default)
2834 db2 DB2
2835 informix Informix
2836 ingres Ingres
2837 interbase Interbase
2838 linter Linter
2839 ms Microsoft
2840 mysql MySQL
2841 oracle Oracle
2842 postgres Postgres
2843 solid Solid
2844 sqlite SQLite
2845 sybase Sybase
2846
2847 The current product name will be shown on the mode line following the
2848 SQL mode indicator.
2849
2850 The technique of setting `sql-mode-font-lock-defaults' directly in
2851 your `.emacs' will no longer establish the default highlighting -- Use
2852 `sql-product' to accomplish this.
2853
2854 ANSI keywords are always highlighted.
2855
2856 *** The function `sql-add-product-keywords' can be used to add
2857 font-lock rules to the product specific rules. For example, to have
2858 all identifiers ending in `_t' under MS SQLServer treated as a type,
2859 you would use the following line in your .emacs file:
2860
2861 (sql-add-product-keywords 'ms
2862 '(("\\<\\w+_t\\>" . font-lock-type-face)))
2863
2864 *** Oracle support includes keyword highlighting for Oracle 9i.
2865
2866 Most SQL and PL/SQL keywords are implemented. SQL*Plus commands are
2867 highlighted in `font-lock-doc-face'.
2868
2869 *** Microsoft SQLServer support has been significantly improved.
2870
2871 Keyword highlighting for SqlServer 2000 is implemented.
2872 sql-interactive-mode defaults to use osql, rather than isql, because
2873 osql flushes its error stream more frequently. Thus error messages
2874 are displayed when they occur rather than when the session is
2875 terminated.
2876
2877 If the username and password are not provided to `sql-ms', osql is
2878 called with the `-E' command line argument to use the operating system
2879 credentials to authenticate the user.
2880
2881 *** Postgres support is enhanced.
2882 Keyword highlighting of Postgres 7.3 is implemented. Prompting for
2883 the username and the pgsql `-U' option is added.
2884
2885 *** MySQL support is enhanced.
2886 Keyword higlighting of MySql 4.0 is implemented.
2887
2888 *** Imenu support has been enhanced to locate tables, views, indexes,
2889 packages, procedures, functions, triggers, sequences, rules, and
2890 defaults.
2891
2892 *** Added SQL->Start SQLi Session menu entry which calls the
2893 appropriate `sql-interactive-mode' wrapper for the current setting of
2894 `sql-product'.
2895
2896 ---
2897 *** sql.el supports the SQLite interpreter--call 'sql-sqlite'.
2898
2899 ** FFAP changes:
2900
2901 +++
2902 *** New ffap commands and keybindings:
2903
2904 C-x C-r (`ffap-read-only'),
2905 C-x C-v (`ffap-alternate-file'), C-x C-d (`ffap-list-directory'),
2906 C-x 4 r (`ffap-read-only-other-window'), C-x 4 d (`ffap-dired-other-window'),
2907 C-x 5 r (`ffap-read-only-other-frame'), C-x 5 d (`ffap-dired-other-frame').
2908
2909 ---
2910 *** FFAP accepts wildcards in a file name by default.
2911
2912 C-x C-f passes the file name to `find-file' with non-nil WILDCARDS
2913 argument, which visits multiple files, and C-x d passes it to `dired'.
2914
2915 ---
2916 ** In skeleton.el, `-' marks the `skeleton-point' without interregion interaction.
2917
2918 `@' has reverted to only setting `skeleton-positions' and no longer
2919 sets `skeleton-point'. Skeletons which used @ to mark
2920 `skeleton-point' independent of `_' should now use `-' instead. The
2921 updated `skeleton-insert' docstring explains these new features along
2922 with other details of skeleton construction.
2923
2924 ---
2925 ** New variable `hs-set-up-overlay' allows customization of the overlay
2926 used to effect hiding for hideshow minor mode. Integration with isearch
2927 handles the overlay property `display' specially, preserving it during
2928 temporary overlay showing in the course of an isearch operation.
2929
2930 +++
2931 ** `hide-ifdef-mode' now uses overlays rather than selective-display
2932 to hide its text. This should be mostly transparent but slightly
2933 changes the behavior of motion commands like C-e and C-p.
2934
2935 ---
2936 ** `partial-completion-mode' now handles partial completion on directory names.
2937
2938 ---
2939 ** The type-break package now allows `type-break-file-name' to be nil
2940 and if so, doesn't store any data across sessions. This is handy if
2941 you don't want the `.type-break' file in your home directory or are
2942 annoyed by the need for interaction when you kill Emacs.
2943
2944 ---
2945 ** `ps-print' can now print characters from the mule-unicode charsets.
2946
2947 Printing text with characters from the mule-unicode-* sets works with
2948 `ps-print', provided that you have installed the appropriate BDF
2949 fonts. See the file INSTALL for URLs where you can find these fonts.
2950
2951 ---
2952 ** New command `strokes-global-set-stroke-string'.
2953 This is like `strokes-global-set-stroke', but it allows you to bind
2954 the stroke directly to a string to insert. This is convenient for
2955 using strokes as an input method.
2956
2957 ** Emacs server changes:
2958
2959 +++
2960 *** You can have several Emacs servers on the same machine.
2961
2962 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "foo")' -f server-start &
2963 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "bar")' -f server-start &
2964 % emacsclient -s foo file1
2965 % emacsclient -s bar file2
2966
2967 +++
2968 *** The `emacsclient' command understands the options `--eval' and
2969 `--display' which tell Emacs respectively to evaluate the given Lisp
2970 expression and to use the given display when visiting files.
2971
2972 +++
2973 *** User option `server-mode' can be used to start a server process.
2974
2975 ---
2976 ** LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
2977
2978 +++
2979 ** You can now disable pc-selection-mode after enabling it.
2980
2981 M-x pc-selection-mode behaves like a proper minor mode, and with no
2982 argument it toggles the mode. Turning off PC-Selection mode restores
2983 the global key bindings that were replaced by turning on the mode.
2984
2985 ---
2986 ** `uniquify-strip-common-suffix' tells uniquify to prefer
2987 `file|dir1' and `file|dir2' to `file|dir1/subdir' and `file|dir2/subdir'.
2988
2989 ---
2990 ** Support for `magic cookie' standout modes has been removed.
2991
2992 Emacs still works on terminals that require magic cookies in order to
2993 use standout mode, but they can no longer display mode-lines in
2994 inverse-video.
2995
2996 ---
2997 ** The game `mpuz' is enhanced.
2998
2999 `mpuz' now allows the 2nd factor not to have two identical digits. By
3000 default, all trivial operations involving whole lines are performed
3001 automatically. The game uses faces for better visual feedback.
3002
3003 ---
3004 ** display-battery-mode replaces display-battery.
3005
3006 ---
3007 ** calculator.el now has radix grouping mode.
3008
3009 To enable this, set `calculator-output-radix' non-nil. In this mode a
3010 separator character is used every few digits, making it easier to see
3011 byte boundries etc. For more info, see the documentation of the
3012 variable `calculator-radix-grouping-mode'.
3013
3014 ---
3015 ** fast-lock.el and lazy-lock.el are obsolete. Use jit-lock.el instead.
3016
3017 ---
3018 ** iso-acc.el is now obsolete. Use one of the latin input methods instead.
3019
3020 ---
3021 ** cplus-md.el has been deleted.
3022 \f
3023 * Changes in Emacs 22.1 on non-free operating systems
3024
3025 +++
3026 ** Passing resources on the command line now works on MS Windows.
3027
3028 You can use --xrm to pass resource settings to Emacs, overriding any
3029 existing values. For example:
3030
3031 emacs --xrm "Emacs.Background:red" --xrm "Emacs.Geometry:100x20"
3032
3033 will start up Emacs on an initial frame of 100x20 with red background,
3034 irrespective of geometry or background setting on the Windows registry.
3035
3036 ---
3037 ** On MS Windows, the "system caret" now follows the cursor.
3038
3039 This enables Emacs to work better with programs that need to track
3040 the cursor, for example screen magnifiers and text to speech programs.
3041
3042 ---
3043 ** Tooltips now work on MS Windows.
3044
3045 See the Emacs 21.1 NEWS entry for tooltips for details.
3046
3047 ---
3048 ** Images are now supported on MS Windows.
3049
3050 PBM and XBM images are supported out of the box. Other image formats
3051 depend on external libraries. All of these libraries have been ported
3052 to Windows, and can be found in both source and binary form at
3053 http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net/. Note that libpng also depends on
3054 zlib, and tiff depends on the version of jpeg that it was compiled
3055 against. For additional information, see nt/INSTALL.
3056
3057 ---
3058 ** Sound is now supported on MS Windows.
3059
3060 WAV format is supported on all versions of Windows, other formats such
3061 as AU, AIFF and MP3 may be supported in the more recent versions of
3062 Windows, or when other software provides hooks into the system level
3063 sound support for those formats.
3064
3065 ---
3066 ** Different shaped mouse pointers are supported on MS Windows.
3067
3068 The mouse pointer changes shape depending on what is under the pointer.
3069
3070 ---
3071 ** Pointing devices with more than 3 buttons are now supported on MS Windows.
3072
3073 The new variable `w32-pass-extra-mouse-buttons-to-system' controls
3074 whether Emacs should handle the extra buttons itself (the default), or
3075 pass them to Windows to be handled with system-wide functions.
3076
3077 ---
3078 ** Emacs takes note of colors defined in Control Panel on MS-Windows.
3079
3080 The Control Panel defines some default colors for applications in much
3081 the same way as wildcard X Resources do on X. Emacs now adds these
3082 colors to the colormap prefixed by System (eg SystemMenu for the
3083 default Menu background, SystemMenuText for the foreground), and uses
3084 some of them to initialize some of the default faces.
3085 `list-colors-display' shows the list of System color names, in case
3086 you wish to use them in other faces.
3087
3088 ---
3089 ** On MS Windows NT/W2K/XP, Emacs uses Unicode for clipboard operations.
3090
3091 Those systems use Unicode internally, so this allows Emacs to share
3092 multilingual text with other applications. On other versions of
3093 MS Windows, Emacs now uses the appropriate locale coding-system, so
3094 the clipboard should work correctly for your local language without
3095 any customizations.
3096
3097 ---
3098 ** On Mac OS, `keyboard-coding-system' changes based on the keyboard script.
3099
3100 ---
3101 ** The variable `mac-keyboard-text-encoding' and the constants
3102 `kTextEncodingMacRoman', `kTextEncodingISOLatin1', and
3103 `kTextEncodingISOLatin2' are obsolete.
3104 \f
3105 * Incompatible Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3106
3107 ---
3108 ** The variables post-command-idle-hook and post-command-idle-delay have
3109 been removed. Use run-with-idle-timer instead.
3110
3111 +++
3112 ** `suppress-keymap' now works by remapping `self-insert-command' to
3113 the command `undefined'. (In earlier Emacs versions, it used
3114 `substitute-key-definition' to rebind self inserting characters to
3115 `undefined'.)
3116
3117 +++
3118 ** Mode line display ignores text properties as well as the
3119 :propertize and :eval forms in the value of a variable whose
3120 `risky-local-variable' property is nil.
3121
3122 ---
3123 ** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
3124 \f
3125 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3126
3127 ** General Lisp changes:
3128
3129 +++
3130 *** The function `eql' is now available without requiring the CL package.
3131
3132 +++
3133 *** `makehash' is now obsolete. Use `make-hash-table' instead.
3134
3135 +++
3136 *** `add-to-list' takes an optional third argument, APPEND.
3137
3138 If APPEND is non-nil, the new element gets added at the end of the
3139 list instead of at the beginning. This change actually occurred in
3140 Emacs 21.1, but was not documented then.
3141
3142 +++
3143 *** New function `copy-tree' makes a copy of a tree.
3144
3145 It recursively copyies through both CARs and CDRs.
3146
3147 +++
3148 *** New function `delete-dups' deletes `equal' duplicate elements from a list.
3149
3150 It modifies the list destructively, like `delete'. Of several `equal'
3151 occurrences of an element in the list, the one that's kept is the
3152 first one.
3153
3154 +++
3155 *** New function `rassq-delete-all'.
3156
3157 (rassq-delete-all VALUE ALIST) deletes, from ALIST, each element whose
3158 CDR is `eq' to the specified value.
3159
3160 +++
3161 *** The function `number-sequence' makes a list of equally-separated numbers.
3162
3163 For instance, (number-sequence 4 9) returns (4 5 6 7 8 9). By
3164 default, the separation is 1, but you can specify a different
3165 separation as the third argument. (number-sequence 1.5 6 2) returns
3166 (1.5 3.5 5.5).
3167
3168 +++
3169 *** New variables `most-positive-fixnum' and `most-negative-fixnum'.
3170
3171 They hold the largest and smallest possible integer values.
3172
3173 +++
3174 *** Minor change in the function `format'.
3175
3176 Some flags that were accepted but not implemented (such as "*") are no
3177 longer accepted.
3178
3179 +++
3180 *** Functions `get' and `plist-get' no longer give errors for bad plists.
3181
3182 They return nil for a malformed property list or if the list is
3183 cyclic.
3184
3185 +++
3186 *** New functions `lax-plist-get' and `lax-plist-put'.
3187
3188 They are like `plist-get' and `plist-put', except that they compare
3189 the property name using `equal' rather than `eq'.
3190
3191 +++
3192 *** New variable `print-continuous-numbering'.
3193
3194 When this is non-nil, successive calls to print functions use a single
3195 numbering scheme for circular structure references. This is only
3196 relevant when `print-circle' is non-nil.
3197
3198 When you bind `print-continuous-numbering' to t, you should
3199 also bind `print-number-table' to nil.
3200
3201 +++
3202 *** New function `macroexpand-all' expands all macros in a form.
3203
3204 It is similar to the Common-Lisp function of the same name.
3205 One difference is that it guarantees to return the original argument
3206 if no expansion is done, which can be tested using `eq'.
3207
3208 +++
3209 *** The function `atan' now accepts an optional second argument.
3210
3211 When called with 2 arguments, as in `(atan Y X)', `atan' returns the
3212 angle in radians between the vector [X, Y] and the X axis. (This is
3213 equivalent to the standard C library function `atan2'.)
3214
3215 +++
3216 *** A function or macro's doc string can now specify the calling pattern.
3217
3218 You put this info in the doc string's last line. It should be
3219 formatted so as to match the regexp "\n\n(fn .*)\\'". If you don't
3220 specify this explicitly, Emacs determines it from the actual argument
3221 names. Usually that default is right, but not always.
3222
3223 +++
3224 *** New macro `with-local-quit' temporarily allows quitting.
3225
3226 A quit inside the body of `with-local-quit' is caught by the
3227 `with-local-quit' form itself, but another quit will happen later once
3228 the code that has inhibitted quitting exits.
3229
3230 This is for use around potentially blocking or long-running code
3231 inside timer functions and `post-command-hook' functions.
3232
3233 +++
3234 *** New macro `define-obsolete-function-alias'.
3235
3236 This combines `defalias' and `make-obsolete'.
3237
3238 +++
3239 *** New function `unsafep' determines whether a Lisp form is safe.
3240
3241 It returns nil if the given Lisp form can't possibly do anything
3242 dangerous; otherwise it returns a reason why the form might be unsafe
3243 (calls unknown function, alters global variable, etc).
3244
3245 *** `list-faces-display' takes an optional argument, REGEXP.
3246
3247 If it is non-nil, the function lists only faces matching this regexp.
3248
3249 ** Lisp code indentation features:
3250
3251 +++
3252 *** The `defmacro' form can contain indentation and edebug declarations.
3253
3254 These declarations specify how to indent the macro calls in Lisp mode
3255 and how to debug them with Edebug. You write them like this:
3256
3257 (defmacro NAME LAMBDA-LIST [DOC-STRING] [DECLARATION ...] ...)
3258
3259 DECLARATION is a list `(declare DECLARATION-SPECIFIER ...)'. The
3260 possible declaration specifiers are:
3261
3262 (indent INDENT)
3263 Set NAME's `lisp-indent-function' property to INDENT.
3264
3265 (edebug DEBUG)
3266 Set NAME's `edebug-form-spec' property to DEBUG. (This is
3267 equivalent to writing a `def-edebug-spec' for the macro,
3268 but this is cleaner.)
3269
3270 ---
3271 *** cl-indent now allows customization of Indentation of backquoted forms.
3272
3273 See the new user option `lisp-backquote-indentation'.
3274
3275 ---
3276 *** cl-indent now handles indentation of simple and extended `loop' forms.
3277
3278 The new user options `lisp-loop-keyword-indentation',
3279 `lisp-loop-forms-indentation', and `lisp-simple-loop-indentation' can
3280 be used to customize the indentation of keywords and forms in loop
3281 forms.
3282
3283 +++
3284 ** Variable aliases:
3285
3286 *** New function: defvaralias ALIAS-VAR BASE-VAR [DOCSTRING]
3287
3288 This function defines the symbol ALIAS-VAR as a variable alias for
3289 symbol BASE-VAR. This means that retrieving the value of ALIAS-VAR
3290 returns the value of BASE-VAR, and changing the value of ALIAS-VAR
3291 changes the value of BASE-VAR.
3292
3293 DOCSTRING, if present, is the documentation for ALIAS-VAR; else it has
3294 the same documentation as BASE-VAR.
3295
3296 *** New function: indirect-variable VARIABLE
3297
3298 This function returns the variable at the end of the chain of aliases
3299 of VARIABLE. If VARIABLE is not a symbol, or if VARIABLE is not
3300 defined as an alias, the function returns VARIABLE.
3301
3302 It might be noteworthy that variables aliases work for all kinds of
3303 variables, including buffer-local and frame-local variables.
3304
3305 +++
3306 *** The macro `define-obsolete-variable-alias' combines `defvaralias' and
3307 `make-obsolete-variable'.
3308
3309 ** defcustom changes:
3310
3311 +++
3312 *** The new customization type `float' requires a floating point number.
3313
3314 ** String changes:
3315
3316 +++
3317 *** The escape sequence \s is now interpreted as a SPACE character.
3318
3319 Exception: In a character constant, if it is followed by a `-' in a
3320 character constant (e.g. ?\s-A), it is still interpreted as the super
3321 modifier. In strings, \s is always interpreted as a space.
3322
3323 +++
3324 *** A hex escape in a string constant forces the string to be multibyte.
3325
3326 +++
3327 *** An octal escape in a string constant forces the string to be unibyte.
3328
3329 +++
3330 *** `split-string' now includes null substrings in the returned list if
3331 the optional argument SEPARATORS is non-nil and there are matches for
3332 SEPARATORS at the beginning or end of the string. If SEPARATORS is
3333 nil, or if the new optional third argument OMIT-NULLS is non-nil, all
3334 empty matches are omitted from the returned list.
3335
3336 +++
3337 *** New function `string-to-multibyte' converts a unibyte string to a
3338 multibyte string with the same individual character codes.
3339
3340 +++
3341 *** New function `substring-no-properties' returns a substring without
3342 text properties.
3343
3344 +++
3345 *** The new function `assoc-string' replaces `assoc-ignore-case' and
3346 `assoc-ignore-representation', which are still available, but have
3347 been declared obsolete.
3348
3349 +++
3350 ** Displaying warnings to the user.
3351
3352 See the functions `warn' and `display-warning', or the Lisp Manual.
3353 If you want to be sure the warning will not be overlooked, this
3354 facility is much better than using `message', since it displays
3355 warnings in a separate window.
3356
3357 +++
3358 ** Progress reporters.
3359
3360 These provide a simple and uniform way for commands to present
3361 progress messages for the user.
3362
3363 See the new functions `make-progress-reporter',
3364 `progress-reporter-update', `progress-reporter-force-update',
3365 `progress-reporter-done', and `dotimes-with-progress-reporter'.
3366
3367 ** Buffer positions:
3368
3369 +++
3370 *** Function `compute-motion' now calculates the usable window
3371 width if the WIDTH argument is nil. If the TOPOS argument is nil,
3372 the usable window height and width is used.
3373
3374 +++
3375 *** The `line-move', `scroll-up', and `scroll-down' functions will now
3376 modify the window vscroll to scroll through display rows that are
3377 taller that the height of the window, for example in the presence of
3378 large images. To disable this feature, bind the new variable
3379 `auto-window-vscroll' to nil.
3380
3381 +++
3382 *** The argument to `forward-word', `backward-word' is optional.
3383
3384 It defaults to 1.
3385
3386 +++
3387 *** Argument to `forward-to-indentation' and `backward-to-indentation' is optional.
3388
3389 It defaults to 1.
3390
3391 +++
3392 *** New function `mouse-on-link-p' test if a position is in a clickable link.
3393
3394 This is the function used by the new `mouse-1-click-follows-link'
3395 functionality.
3396
3397 +++
3398 *** New function `line-number-at-pos' returns the line number of a position.
3399
3400 It an optional buffer position argument that defaults to point.
3401
3402 +++
3403 *** `field-beginning' and `field-end' take new optional argument, LIMIT.
3404
3405 This argument tells them not to search beyond LIMIT. Instead they
3406 give up and return LIMIT.
3407
3408 +++
3409 *** Function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now returns the pixel coordinates
3410 and partial visiblity state of the corresponding row, if the PARTIALLY
3411 arg is non-nil.
3412
3413 +++
3414 *** New functions `posn-at-point' and `posn-at-x-y' return
3415 click-event-style position information for a given visible buffer
3416 position or for a given window pixel coordinate.
3417
3418 ** Text modification:
3419
3420 +++
3421 *** The new function `insert-for-yank' normally works like `insert', but
3422 removes the text properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list
3423 and handles the `yank-handler' text property.
3424
3425 +++
3426 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-as-yank' is like
3427 `insert-for-yank' except that it gets the text from another buffer as
3428 in `insert-buffer-substring'.
3429
3430 +++
3431 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-no-properties' is like
3432 `insert-buffer-substring', but removes all text properties from the
3433 inserted substring.
3434
3435 +++
3436 *** The new function `filter-buffer-substring' extracts a buffer
3437 substring, passes it through a set of filter functions, and returns
3438 the filtered substring. Use it instead of `buffer-substring' or
3439 `delete-and-extract-region' when copying text into a user-accessible
3440 data structure, such as the kill-ring, X clipboard, or a register.
3441
3442 The list of filter function is specified by the new variable
3443 `buffer-substring-filters'. For example, Longlines mode adds to
3444 `buffer-substring-filters' to remove soft newlines from the copied
3445 text.
3446
3447 +++
3448 *** Function `translate-region' accepts also a char-table as TABLE
3449 argument.
3450
3451 +++
3452 *** The new translation table `translation-table-for-input'
3453 is used for customizing self-insertion. The character to
3454 be inserted is translated through it.
3455
3456 ---
3457 *** Text clones.
3458
3459 The new function `text-clone-create'. Text clones are chunks of text
3460 that are kept identical by transparently propagating changes from one
3461 clone to the other.
3462
3463 ---
3464 *** The function `insert-string' is now obsolete.
3465
3466 +++
3467 ** Atomic change groups.
3468
3469 To perform some changes in the current buffer "atomically" so that
3470 they either all succeed or are all undone, use `atomic-change-group'
3471 around the code that makes changes. For instance:
3472
3473 (atomic-change-group
3474 (insert foo)
3475 (delete-region x y))
3476
3477 If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of
3478 `atomic-change-group', it unmakes all the changes in that buffer that
3479 were during the execution of the body. The change group has no effect
3480 on any other buffers--any such changes remain.
3481
3482 If you need something more sophisticated, you can directly call the
3483 lower-level functions that `atomic-change-group' uses. Here is how.
3484
3485 To set up a change group for one buffer, call `prepare-change-group'.
3486 Specify the buffer as argument; it defaults to the current buffer.
3487 This function returns a "handle" for the change group. You must save
3488 the handle to activate the change group and then finish it.
3489
3490 Before you change the buffer again, you must activate the change
3491 group. Pass the handle to `activate-change-group' afterward to
3492 do this.
3493
3494 After you make the changes, you must finish the change group. You can
3495 either accept the changes or cancel them all. Call
3496 `accept-change-group' to accept the changes in the group as final;
3497 call `cancel-change-group' to undo them all.
3498
3499 You should use `unwind-protect' to make sure the group is always
3500 finished. The call to `activate-change-group' should be inside the
3501 `unwind-protect', in case the user types C-g just after it runs.
3502 (This is one reason why `prepare-change-group' and
3503 `activate-change-group' are separate functions.) Once you finish the
3504 group, don't use the handle again--don't try to finish the same group
3505 twice.
3506
3507 To make a multibuffer change group, call `prepare-change-group' once
3508 for each buffer you want to cover, then use `nconc' to combine the
3509 returned values, like this:
3510
3511 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1)
3512 (prepare-change-group buffer-2))
3513
3514 You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call
3515 to `activate-change-group', and finish it with a single call to
3516 `accept-change-group' or `cancel-change-group'.
3517
3518 Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you
3519 would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer
3520 will lead to undesirable results, so don't let it happen; the first
3521 change group you start for any given buffer should be the last one
3522 finished.
3523
3524 ** Buffer-related changes:
3525
3526 ---
3527 *** `list-buffers-noselect' now takes an additional argument, BUFFER-LIST.
3528
3529 If it is non-nil, it specifies which buffers to list.
3530
3531 +++
3532 *** `kill-buffer-hook' is now a permanent local.
3533
3534 +++
3535 *** The new function `buffer-local-value' returns the buffer-local
3536 binding of VARIABLE (a symbol) in buffer BUFFER. If VARIABLE does not
3537 have a buffer-local binding in buffer BUFFER, it returns the default
3538 value of VARIABLE instead.
3539
3540 ** Local variables lists:
3541
3542 +++
3543 *** Text properties in local variables.
3544
3545 A file local variables list cannot specify a string with text
3546 properties--any specified text properties are discarded.
3547
3548 +++
3549 *** The variable `safe-local-eval-forms' specifies a list of forms that
3550 are ok to evaluate when they appear in an `eval' local variables
3551 specification. Normally Emacs asks for confirmation before evaluating
3552 such a form, but if the form appears in this list, no confirmation is
3553 needed.
3554
3555 ---
3556 *** If a function has a non-nil `safe-local-eval-function' property,
3557 that means it is ok to evaluate some calls to that function when it
3558 appears in an `eval' local variables specification. If the property
3559 is t, then any form calling that function with constant arguments is
3560 ok. If the property is a function or list of functions, they are called
3561 with the form as argument, and if any returns t, the form is ok to call.
3562
3563 If the form is not "ok to call", that means Emacs asks for
3564 confirmation as before.
3565
3566 ** Searching and matching changes:
3567
3568 +++
3569 *** New function `looking-back' checks whether a regular expression matches
3570 the text before point. Specifying the LIMIT argument bounds how far
3571 back the match can start; this is a way to keep it from taking too long.
3572
3573 +++
3574 *** The new variable `search-spaces-regexp' controls how to search
3575 for spaces in a regular expression. If it is non-nil, it should be a
3576 regular expression, and any series of spaces stands for that regular
3577 expression. If it is nil, spaces stand for themselves.
3578
3579 Spaces inside of constructs such as `[..]' and inside loops such as
3580 `*', `+', and `?' are never replaced with `search-spaces-regexp'.
3581
3582 +++
3583 *** New regular expression operators, `\_<' and `\_>'.
3584
3585 These match the beginning and end of a symbol. A symbol is a
3586 non-empty sequence of either word or symbol constituent characters, as
3587 specified by the syntax table.
3588
3589 ---
3590 *** rx.el has new corresponding `symbol-end' and `symbol-start' elements.
3591
3592 +++
3593 *** `skip-chars-forward' and `skip-chars-backward' now handle
3594 character classes such as `[:alpha:]', along with individual
3595 characters and ranges.
3596
3597 ---
3598 *** In `replace-match', the replacement text no longer inherits
3599 properties from surrounding text.
3600
3601 +++
3602 *** The list returned by `(match-data t)' now has the buffer as a final
3603 element, if the last match was on a buffer. `set-match-data'
3604 accepts such a list for restoring the match state.
3605
3606 +++
3607 *** Functions `match-data' and `set-match-data' now have an optional
3608 argument `reseat'. When non-nil, all markers in the match data list
3609 passed to these function will be reseated to point to nowhere, and if
3610 the value of `reseat' is `evaporate', the markers are put onto the
3611 free list. Note that no other references to those markers must exist
3612 if `evaporate' is specified for the `reseat' argument.
3613
3614 +++
3615 *** The default value of `sentence-end' is now defined using the new
3616 variable `sentence-end-without-space', which contains such characters
3617 that end a sentence without following spaces.
3618
3619 The function `sentence-end' should be used to obtain the value of the
3620 variable `sentence-end'. If the variable `sentence-end' is nil, then
3621 this function returns the regexp constructed from the variables
3622 `sentence-end-without-period', `sentence-end-double-space' and
3623 `sentence-end-without-space'.
3624
3625 ** Undo changes:
3626
3627 +++
3628 *** `buffer-undo-list' can allows programmable elements.
3629
3630 These elements have the form (apply FUNNAME . ARGS), where FUNNAME is
3631 a symbol other than t or nil. That stands for a high-level change
3632 that should be undone by evaluating (apply FUNNAME ARGS).
3633
3634 These entries can also have the form (apply DELTA BEG END FUNNAME . ARGS)
3635 which indicates that the change which took place was limited to the
3636 range BEG...END and increased the buffer size by DELTA.
3637
3638 +++
3639 *** If the buffer's undo list for the current command gets longer than
3640 `undo-outer-limit', garbage collection empties it. This is to prevent
3641 it from using up the available memory and choking Emacs.
3642
3643 +++
3644 ** New `yank-handler' text property can be used to control how
3645 previously killed text on the kill ring is reinserted.
3646
3647 The value of the `yank-handler' property must be a list with one to four
3648 elements with the following format:
3649 (FUNCTION PARAM NOEXCLUDE UNDO).
3650
3651 The `insert-for-yank' function looks for a yank-handler property on
3652 the first character on its string argument (typically the first
3653 element on the kill-ring). If a `yank-handler' property is found,
3654 the normal behavior of `insert-for-yank' is modified in various ways:
3655
3656 When FUNCTION is present and non-nil, it is called instead of `insert'
3657 to insert the string. FUNCTION takes one argument--the object to insert.
3658 If PARAM is present and non-nil, it replaces STRING as the object
3659 passed to FUNCTION (or `insert'); for example, if FUNCTION is
3660 `yank-rectangle', PARAM should be a list of strings to insert as a
3661 rectangle.
3662 If NOEXCLUDE is present and non-nil, the normal removal of the
3663 `yank-excluded-properties' is not performed; instead FUNCTION is
3664 responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary
3665 if FUNCTION adjusts point before or after inserting the object.
3666 If UNDO is present and non-nil, it is a function that will be called
3667 by `yank-pop' to undo the insertion of the current object. It is
3668 called with two arguments, the start and end of the current region.
3669 FUNCTION can set `yank-undo-function' to override the UNDO value.
3670
3671 *** The functions `kill-new', `kill-append', and `kill-region' now have an
3672 optional argument to specify the `yank-handler' text property to put on
3673 the killed text.
3674
3675 *** The function `yank-pop' will now use a non-nil value of the variable
3676 `yank-undo-function' (instead of `delete-region') to undo the previous
3677 `yank' or `yank-pop' command (or a call to `insert-for-yank'). The function
3678 `insert-for-yank' automatically sets that variable according to the UNDO
3679 element of the string argument's `yank-handler' text property if present.
3680
3681 *** The function `insert-for-yank' now supports strings where the
3682 `yank-handler' property does not span the first character of the
3683 string. The old behavior is available if you call
3684 `insert-for-yank-1' instead.
3685
3686 ** Syntax table changes:
3687
3688 +++
3689 *** The macro `with-syntax-table' no longer copies the syntax table.
3690
3691 +++
3692 *** The new function `syntax-after' returns the syntax code
3693 of the character after a specified buffer position, taking account
3694 of text properties as well as the character code.
3695
3696 +++
3697 *** `syntax-class' extracts the class of a syntax code (as returned
3698 by `syntax-after').
3699
3700 *** The new function `syntax-ppss' rovides an efficient way to find the
3701 current syntactic context at point.
3702
3703 ** File operation changes:
3704
3705 +++
3706 *** New vars `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' used when
3707 searching for an executable or an Emacs Lisp file.
3708
3709 +++
3710 *** The new primitive `set-file-times' sets a file's access and
3711 modification times. Magic file name handlers can handle this
3712 operation.
3713
3714 +++
3715 *** The new function `file-remote-p' tests a file name and returns
3716 non-nil if it specifies a remote file (one that Emacs accesses using
3717 its own special methods and not directly through the file system).
3718 The value in that case is an identifier for the remote file system.
3719
3720 +++
3721 *** `buffer-auto-save-file-format' is the new name for what was
3722 formerly called `auto-save-file-format'. It is now a permanent local.
3723
3724 +++
3725 *** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
3726 ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
3727 `.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
3728
3729 +++
3730 *** `copy-file' now takes an additional option arg MUSTBENEW.
3731
3732 This argument works like the MUSTBENEW argument of write-file.
3733
3734 +++
3735 *** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return
3736 a list of two integers, instead of a cons.
3737
3738 +++
3739 *** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
3740 specifies the maximum number of links to chase through. If after that
3741 many iterations the file name obtained is still a symbolic link,
3742 `file-chase-links' returns it anyway.
3743
3744 +++
3745 *** The new hook `before-save-hook' is invoked by `basic-save-buffer'
3746 before saving buffers. This allows packages to perform various final
3747 tasks, for example; it can be used by the copyright package to make
3748 sure saved files have the current year in any copyright headers.
3749
3750 +++
3751 *** If `buffer-save-without-query' is non-nil in some buffer,
3752 `save-some-buffers' will always save that buffer without asking (if
3753 it's modified).
3754
3755 +++
3756 *** New function `locate-file' searches for a file in a list of directories.
3757 `locate-file' accepts a name of a file to search (a string), and two
3758 lists: a list of directories to search in and a list of suffixes to
3759 try; typical usage might use `exec-path' and `load-path' for the list
3760 of directories, and `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' for the list
3761 of suffixes. The function also accepts a predicate argument to
3762 further filter candidate files.
3763
3764 One advantage of using this function is that the list of suffixes in
3765 `exec-suffixes' is OS-dependant, so this function will find
3766 executables without polluting Lisp code with OS dependancies.
3767
3768 ---
3769 *** The precedence of file name handlers has been changed.
3770
3771 Instead of choosing the first handler that matches,
3772 `find-file-name-handler' now gives precedence to a file name handler
3773 that matches nearest the end of the file name. More precisely, the
3774 handler whose (match-beginning 0) is the largest is chosen. In case
3775 of ties, the old "first matched" rule applies.
3776
3777 +++
3778 *** A file name handler can declare which operations it handles.
3779
3780 You do this by putting an `operation' property on the handler name
3781 symbol. The property value should be a list of the operations that
3782 the handler really handles. It won't be called for any other
3783 operations.
3784
3785 This is useful for autoloaded handlers, to prevent them from being
3786 autoloaded when not really necessary.
3787
3788 ** Input changes:
3789
3790 +++
3791 *** An interactive specification can now use the code letter 'U' to get
3792 the up-event that was discarded in case the last key sequence read for a
3793 previous `k' or `K' argument was a down-event; otherwise nil is used.
3794
3795 +++
3796 *** The new interactive-specification `G' reads a file name
3797 much like `F', but if the input is a directory name (even defaulted),
3798 it returns just the directory name.
3799
3800 ---
3801 *** Functions `y-or-n-p', `read-char', `read-key-sequence' and the like, that
3802 display a prompt but don't use the minibuffer, now display the prompt
3803 using the text properties (esp. the face) of the prompt string.
3804
3805 +++
3806 *** (while-no-input BODY...) runs BODY, but only so long as no input
3807 arrives. If the user types or clicks anything, BODY stops as if a
3808 quit had occurred. `while-no-input' returns the value of BODY, if BODY
3809 finishes. It returns nil if BODY was aborted.
3810
3811 ** Minibuffer changes:
3812
3813 +++
3814 *** The new function `minibufferp' returns non-nil if its optional
3815 buffer argument is a minibuffer. If the argument is omitted, it
3816 defaults to the current buffer.
3817
3818 +++
3819 *** New function `minibuffer-selected-window' returns the window which
3820 was selected when entering the minibuffer.
3821
3822 +++
3823 *** `read-from-minibuffer' now accepts an additional argument KEEP-ALL
3824 saying to put all inputs in the history list, even empty ones.
3825
3826 +++
3827 *** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
3828 specifies a predicate which the file name read must satify. The
3829 new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
3830 while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
3831 variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
3832
3833 ---
3834 *** The new variable `read-file-name-function' can be used by Lisp code
3835 to override the built-in `read-file-name' function.
3836
3837 +++
3838 *** The new variable `read-file-name-completion-ignore-case' specifies
3839 whether completion ignores case when reading a file name with the
3840 `read-file-name' function.
3841
3842 +++
3843 *** The new function `read-directory-name' for reading a directory name.
3844
3845 It is like `read-file-name' except that the defaulting works better
3846 for directories, and completion inside it shows only directories.
3847
3848 ** Completion changes:
3849
3850 +++
3851 *** The functions `all-completions' and `try-completion' now accept lists
3852 of strings as well as hash-tables additionally to alists, obarrays
3853 and functions. Furthermore, the function `test-completion' is now
3854 exported to Lisp. The keys in alists and hash tables can be either
3855 strings or symbols, which are automatically converted with to strings.
3856
3857 +++
3858 *** The new macro `dynamic-completion-table' supports using functions
3859 as a dynamic completion table.
3860
3861 (dynamic-completion-table FUN)
3862
3863 FUN is called with one argument, the string for which completion is required,
3864 and it should return an alist containing all the intended possible
3865 completions. This alist can be a full list of possible completions so that FUN
3866 can ignore the value of its argument. If completion is performed in the
3867 minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer from which the minibuffer was
3868 entered. `dynamic-completion-table' then computes the completion.
3869
3870 +++
3871 *** The new macro `lazy-completion-table' initializes a variable
3872 as a lazy completion table.
3873
3874 (lazy-completion-table VAR FUN &rest ARGS)
3875
3876 If the completion table VAR is used for the first time (e.g., by passing VAR
3877 as an argument to `try-completion'), the function FUN is called with arguments
3878 ARGS. FUN must return the completion table that will be stored in VAR. If
3879 completion is requested in the minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer
3880 from which the minibuffer was entered. The return value of
3881 `lazy-completion-table' must be used to initialize the value of VAR.
3882
3883 +++
3884 ** Enhancements to keymaps.
3885
3886 *** Cleaner way to enter key sequences.
3887
3888 You can enter a constant key sequence in a more natural format, the
3889 same one used for saving keyboard macros, using the macro `kbd'. For
3890 example,
3891
3892 (kbd "C-x C-f") => "\^x\^f"
3893
3894 *** Interactive commands can be remapped through keymaps.
3895
3896 This is an alternative to using `defadvice' or `substitute-key-definition'
3897 to modify the behavior of a key binding using the normal keymap
3898 binding and lookup functionality.
3899
3900 When a key sequence is bound to a command, and that command is
3901 remapped to another command, that command is run instead of the
3902 original command.
3903
3904 Example:
3905 Suppose that minor mode `my-mode' has defined the commands
3906 `my-kill-line' and `my-kill-word', and it wants C-k (and any other key
3907 bound to `kill-line') to run the command `my-kill-line' instead of
3908 `kill-line', and likewise it wants to run `my-kill-word' instead of
3909 `kill-word'.
3910
3911 Instead of rebinding C-k and the other keys in the minor mode map,
3912 command remapping allows you to directly map `kill-line' into
3913 `my-kill-line' and `kill-word' into `my-kill-word' using `define-key':
3914
3915 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-line] 'my-kill-line)
3916 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-word] 'my-kill-word)
3917
3918 When `my-mode' is enabled, its minor mode keymap is enabled too. So
3919 when the user types C-k, that runs the command `my-kill-line'.
3920
3921 Only one level of remapping is supported. In the above example, this
3922 means that if `my-kill-line' is remapped to `other-kill', then C-k still
3923 runs `my-kill-line'.
3924
3925 The following changes have been made to provide command remapping:
3926
3927 - Command remappings are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
3928 `remap', i.e. `(define-key MAP [remap CMD] DEF)' remaps command CMD
3929 to definition DEF in keymap MAP. The definition is not limited to
3930 another command; it can be anything accepted for a normal binding.
3931
3932 - The new function `command-remapping' returns the binding for a
3933 remapped command in the current keymaps, or nil if not remapped.
3934
3935 - `key-binding' now remaps interactive commands unless the optional
3936 third argument NO-REMAP is non-nil.
3937
3938 - `where-is-internal' now returns nil for a remapped command (e.g.
3939 `kill-line', when `my-mode' is enabled), and the actual key binding for
3940 the command it is remapped to (e.g. C-k for my-kill-line).
3941 It also has a new optional fifth argument, NO-REMAP, which inhibits
3942 remapping if non-nil (e.g. it returns "C-k" for `kill-line', and
3943 "<kill-line>" for `my-kill-line').
3944
3945 - The new variable `this-original-command' contains the original
3946 command before remapping. It is equal to `this-command' when the
3947 command was not remapped.
3948
3949 *** If text has a `keymap' property, that keymap takes precedence
3950 over minor mode keymaps.
3951
3952 *** The `keymap' property now also works at the ends of overlays and
3953 text properties, according to their stickiness. This also means that it
3954 works with empty overlays. The same hold for the `local-map' property.
3955
3956 *** Dense keymaps now handle inheritance correctly.
3957
3958 Previously a dense keymap would hide all of the simple-char key
3959 bindings of the parent keymap.
3960
3961 *** `define-key-after' now accepts keys longer than 1.
3962
3963 *** New function `current-active-maps' returns a list of currently
3964 active keymaps.
3965
3966 *** New function `describe-buffer-bindings' inserts the list of all
3967 defined keys and their definitions.
3968
3969 *** New function `keymap-prompt' returns the prompt string of a keymap.
3970
3971 *** (map-keymap FUNCTION KEYMAP) applies the function to each binding
3972 in the keymap.
3973
3974 *** New variable `emulation-mode-map-alists'.
3975
3976 Lisp packages using many minor mode keymaps can now maintain their own
3977 keymap alist separate from `minor-mode-map-alist' by adding their
3978 keymap alist to this list.
3979
3980 ** Abbrev changes:
3981
3982 +++
3983 *** The new function `copy-abbrev-table' copies an abbrev table.
3984
3985 It returns a new abbrev table that is a copy of a given abbrev table.
3986
3987 +++
3988 *** `define-abbrev' now accepts an optional argument SYSTEM-FLAG.
3989
3990 If non-nil, this marks the abbrev as a "system" abbrev, which means
3991 that it won't be stored in the user's abbrevs file if he saves the
3992 abbrevs. Major modes that predefine some abbrevs should always
3993 specify this flag.
3994
3995 +++
3996 ** Enhancements to process support
3997
3998 *** Function `list-processes' now has an optional argument; if non-nil,
3999 it lists only the processes whose query-on-exit flag is set.
4000
4001 *** New fns `set-process-query-on-exit-flag' and `process-query-on-exit-flag'.
4002
4003 These replace the old function `process-kill-without-query'. That
4004 function is still supported, but new code should use the new
4005 functions.
4006
4007 *** Function `signal-process' now accepts a process object or process
4008 name in addition to a process id to identify the signalled process.
4009
4010 *** Processes now have an associated property list where programs can
4011 maintain process state and other per-process related information.
4012
4013 Use the new functions `process-get' and `process-put' to access, add,
4014 and modify elements on this property list. Use the new functions
4015 `process-plist' and `set-process-plist' to access and replace the
4016 entire property list of a process.
4017
4018 *** Function `accept-process-output' has a new optional fourth arg
4019 JUST-THIS-ONE. If non-nil, only output from the specified process
4020 is handled, suspending output from other processes. If value is an
4021 integer, also inhibit running timers. This feature is generally not
4022 recommended, but may be necessary for specific applications, such as
4023 speech synthesis.
4024
4025 *** Adaptive read buffering of subprocess output.
4026
4027 On some systems, when emacs reads the output from a subprocess, the
4028 output data is read in very small blocks, potentially resulting in
4029 very poor performance. This behavior can be remedied to some extent
4030 by setting the new variable `process-adaptive-read-buffering' to a
4031 non-nil value (the default), as it will automatically delay reading
4032 from such processes, to allowing them to produce more output before
4033 emacs tries to read it.
4034
4035 *** The new function `call-process-shell-command'.
4036
4037 This executes a shell command command synchronously in a separate
4038 process.
4039
4040 *** The new function `process-file' is similar to `call-process', but
4041 obeys file handlers. The file handler is chosen based on
4042 `default-directory'.
4043
4044 *** A process filter function gets the output as multibyte string
4045 if the process specifies t for its filter's multibyteness.
4046
4047 That multibyteness is decided by the value of
4048 `default-enable-multibyte-characters' when the process is created, and
4049 you can change it later with `set-process-filter-multibyte'.
4050
4051 *** The new function `set-process-filter-multibyte' sets the
4052 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
4053
4054 *** The new function `process-filter-multibyte-p' returns the
4055 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
4056
4057 *** If a process's coding system is `raw-text' or `no-conversion' and its
4058 buffer is multibyte, the output of the process is at first converted
4059 to multibyte by `string-to-multibyte' then inserted in the buffer.
4060 Previously, it was converted to multibyte by `string-as-multibyte',
4061 which was not compatible with the behavior of file reading.
4062
4063 +++
4064 ** Enhanced networking support.
4065
4066 *** The new `make-network-process' function makes network connections.
4067 It allows opening of stream and datagram connections to a server, as well as
4068 create a stream or datagram server inside emacs.
4069
4070 - A server is started using :server t arg.
4071 - Datagram connection is selected using :type 'datagram arg.
4072 - A server can open on a random port using :service t arg.
4073 - Local sockets are supported using :family 'local arg.
4074 - Non-blocking connect is supported using :nowait t arg.
4075 - The process' property list can be initialized using :plist PLIST arg;
4076 a copy of the server process' property list is automatically inherited
4077 by new client processes created to handle incoming connections.
4078
4079 To test for the availability of a given feature, use featurep like this:
4080 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:type datagram))
4081
4082 *** The old `open-network-stream' now uses `make-network-process'.
4083
4084 *** New functions `process-datagram-address', `set-process-datagram-address'.
4085
4086 These functions are used with datagram-based network processes to get
4087 and set the current address of the remote partner.
4088
4089 *** New function `format-network-address'.
4090
4091 This function reformats the Lisp representation of a network address
4092 to a printable string. For example, an IP address A.B.C.D and port
4093 number P is represented as a five element vector [A B C D P], and the
4094 printable string returned for this vector is "A.B.C.D:P". See the doc
4095 string for other formatting options.
4096
4097 *** `process-contact' has an optional KEY argument.
4098
4099 Depending on this argument, you can get the complete list of network
4100 process properties or a specific property. Using :local or :remote as
4101 the KEY, you get the address of the local or remote end-point.
4102
4103 An Inet address is represented as a 5 element vector, where the first
4104 4 elements contain the IP address and the fifth is the port number.
4105
4106 *** New functions `stop-process' and `continue-process'.
4107
4108 These functions stop and restart communication through a network
4109 connection. For a server process, no connections are accepted in the
4110 stopped state. For a client process, no input is received in the
4111 stopped state.
4112
4113 *** New function `network-interface-list'.
4114
4115 This function returns a list of network interface names and their
4116 current network addresses.
4117
4118 *** New function `network-interface-info'.
4119
4120 This function returns the network address, hardware address, current
4121 status, and other information about a specific network interface.
4122
4123 *** Deleting a network process with `delete-process' calls the sentinel.
4124
4125 The status message passed to the sentinel for a deleted network
4126 process is "deleted". The message passed to the sentinel when the
4127 connection is closed by the remote peer has been changed to
4128 "connection broken by remote peer".
4129
4130 ** Using window objects:
4131
4132 +++
4133 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4134
4135 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line or the
4136 header line.
4137
4138 +++
4139 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4140
4141 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line
4142 or the header line.
4143
4144 +++
4145 *** You can now make a window as short as one line.
4146
4147 A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode
4148 line or a header line, even if the variables `mode-line-format' and
4149 `header-line-format' call for them. A window that is two lines tall
4150 cannot display both a mode line and a header line at once; if the
4151 variables call for both, only the mode line actually appears.
4152
4153 +++
4154 *** The new function `window-inside-edges' returns the edges of the
4155 actual text portion of the window, not including the scroll bar or
4156 divider line, the fringes, the display margins, the header line and
4157 the mode line.
4158
4159 +++
4160 *** The new functions `window-pixel-edges' and `window-inside-pixel-edges'
4161 return window edges in units of pixels, rather than columns and lines.
4162
4163 +++
4164 *** The new macro `with-selected-window' temporarily switches the
4165 selected window without impacting the order of `buffer-list'.
4166
4167 +++
4168 *** `select-window' takes an optional second argument NORECORD.
4169
4170 This is like `switch-to-buffer'.
4171
4172 +++
4173 *** `save-selected-window' now saves and restores the selected window
4174 of every frame. This way, it restores everything that can be changed
4175 by calling `select-window'.
4176
4177 +++
4178 *** `set-window-buffer' has an optional argument KEEP-MARGINS.
4179
4180 If non-nil, that says to preserve the window's current margin, fringe,
4181 and scroll-bar settings.
4182
4183 +++
4184 ** Customizable fringe bitmaps
4185
4186 *** New function `define-fringe-bitmap' can now be used to create new
4187 fringe bitmaps, as well as change the built-in fringe bitmaps.
4188
4189 To change a built-in bitmap, do (require 'fringe) and use the symbol
4190 identifing the bitmap such as `left-truncation or `continued-line'.
4191
4192 *** New function `destroy-fringe-bitmap' deletes a fringe bitmap
4193 or restores a built-in one to its default value.
4194
4195 *** New function `set-fringe-bitmap-face' specifies the face to be
4196 used for a specific fringe bitmap. The face is automatically merged
4197 with the `fringe' face, so normally, the face should only specify the
4198 foreground color of the bitmap.
4199
4200 *** There are new display properties, `left-fringe' and `right-fringe',
4201 that can be used to show a specific bitmap in the left or right fringe
4202 bitmap of the display line.
4203
4204 Format is `display (left-fringe BITMAP [FACE])', where BITMAP is a
4205 symbol identifying a fringe bitmap, either built-in or defined with
4206 `define-fringe-bitmap', and FACE is an optional face name to be used
4207 for displaying the bitmap instead of the default `fringe' face.
4208 When specified, FACE is automatically merged with the `fringe' face.
4209
4210 *** New function `fringe-bitmaps-at-pos' returns the current fringe
4211 bitmaps in the display line at a given buffer position.
4212
4213 ** Other window fringe features:
4214
4215 +++
4216 *** Controlling the default left and right fringe widths.
4217
4218 The default left and right fringe widths for all windows of a frame
4219 can now be controlled by setting the `left-fringe' and `right-fringe'
4220 frame parameters to an integer value specifying the width in pixels.
4221 Setting the width to 0 effectively removes the corresponding fringe.
4222
4223 The actual default fringe widths for the frame may deviate from the
4224 specified widths, since the combined fringe widths must match an
4225 integral number of columns. The extra width is distributed evenly
4226 between the left and right fringe. For force a specific fringe width,
4227 specify the width as a negative integer (if both widths are negative,
4228 only the left fringe gets the specified width).
4229
4230 Setting the width to nil (the default), restores the default fringe
4231 width which is the minimum number of pixels necessary to display any
4232 of the currently defined fringe bitmaps. The width of the built-in
4233 fringe bitmaps is 8 pixels.
4234
4235 +++
4236 *** Per-window fringe and scrollbar settings
4237
4238 **** Windows can now have their own individual fringe widths and
4239 position settings.
4240
4241 To control the fringe widths of a window, either set the buffer-local
4242 variables `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', or call
4243 `set-window-fringes'.
4244
4245 To control the fringe position in a window, that is, whether fringes
4246 are positioned between the display margins and the window's text area,
4247 or at the edges of the window, either set the buffer-local variable
4248 `fringes-outside-margins' or call `set-window-fringes'.
4249
4250 The function `window-fringes' can be used to obtain the current
4251 settings. To make `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', and
4252 `fringes-outside-margins' take effect, you must set them before
4253 displaying the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force
4254 an update of the display margins.
4255
4256 **** Windows can now have their own individual scroll-bar settings
4257 controlling the width and position of scroll-bars.
4258
4259 To control the scroll-bar of a window, either set the buffer-local
4260 variables `scroll-bar-mode' and `scroll-bar-width', or call
4261 `set-window-scroll-bars'. The function `window-scroll-bars' can be
4262 used to obtain the current settings. To make `scroll-bar-mode' and
4263 `scroll-bar-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
4264 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
4265 of the display margins.
4266
4267 ** Redisplay features:
4268
4269 +++
4270 *** `sit-for' can now be called with args (SECONDS &optional NODISP).
4271
4272 +++
4273 *** New function `force-window-update' can initiate a full redisplay of
4274 one or all windows. Normally, this is not needed as changes in window
4275 contents are detected automatically. However, certain implicit
4276 changes to mode lines, header lines, or display properties may require
4277 forcing an explicit window update.
4278
4279 +++
4280 *** (char-displayable-p CHAR) returns non-nil if Emacs ought to be able
4281 to display CHAR. More precisely, if the selected frame's fontset has
4282 a font to display the character set that CHAR belongs to.
4283
4284 Fontsets can specify a font on a per-character basis; when the fontset
4285 does that, this value cannot be accurate.
4286
4287 +++
4288 *** You can define multiple overlay arrows via the new
4289 variable `overlay-arrow-variable-list'.
4290
4291 It contains a list of varibles which contain overlay arrow position
4292 markers, including the original `overlay-arrow-position' variable.
4293
4294 Each variable on this list can have individual `overlay-arrow-string'
4295 and `overlay-arrow-bitmap' properties that specify an overlay arrow
4296 string (for non-window terminals) or fringe bitmap (for window
4297 systems) to display at the corresponding overlay arrow position.
4298 If either property is not set, the default `overlay-arrow-string' or
4299 'overlay-arrow-fringe-bitmap' will be used.
4300
4301 +++
4302 *** New `line-height' and `line-spacing' properties for newline characters
4303
4304 A newline can now have `line-height' and `line-spacing' text or overlay
4305 properties that control the height of the corresponding display row.
4306
4307 If the `line-height' property value is t, the newline does not
4308 contribute to the height of the display row; instead the height of the
4309 newline glyph is reduced. Also, a `line-spacing' property on this
4310 newline is ignored. This can be used to tile small images or image
4311 slices without adding blank areas between the images.
4312
4313 If the `line-height' property value is a positive integer, the value
4314 specifies the minimum line height in pixels. If necessary, the line
4315 height it increased by increasing the line's ascent.
4316
4317 If the `line-height' property value is a float, the minimum line
4318 height is calculated by multiplying the default frame line height by
4319 the given value.
4320
4321 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (FACE . RATIO), the
4322 minimum line height is calculated as RATIO * height of named FACE.
4323 RATIO is int or float. If FACE is t, it specifies the current face.
4324
4325 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (nil . RATIO), the line
4326 height is calculated as RATIO * actual height of the line's contents.
4327
4328 If the `line-height' value is a cons (HEIGHT . TOTAL), HEIGHT specifies
4329 the line height as described above, while TOTAL is any of the forms
4330 described above and specifies the total height of the line, causing a
4331 varying number of pixels to be inserted after the line to make it line
4332 exactly that many pixels high.
4333
4334 If the `line-spacing' property value is an positive integer, the value
4335 is used as additional pixels to insert after the display line; this
4336 overrides the default frame `line-spacing' and any buffer local value of
4337 the `line-spacing' variable.
4338
4339 If the `line-spacing' property is a float or cons, the line spacing
4340 is calculated as specified above for the `line-height' property.
4341
4342 +++
4343 *** The buffer local `line-spacing' variable can now have a float value,
4344 which is used as a height relative to the default frame line height.
4345
4346 +++
4347 *** Enhancements to stretch display properties
4348
4349 The display property stretch specification form `(space PROPS)', where
4350 PROPS is a property list now allows pixel based width and height
4351 specifications, as well as enhanced horizontal text alignment.
4352
4353 The value of these properties can now be a (primitive) expression
4354 which is evaluated during redisplay. The following expressions
4355 are supported:
4356
4357 EXPR ::= NUM | (NUM) | UNIT | ELEM | POS | IMAGE | FORM
4358 NUM ::= INTEGER | FLOAT | SYMBOL
4359 UNIT ::= in | mm | cm | width | height
4360 ELEM ::= left-fringe | right-fringe | left-margin | right-margin
4361 | scroll-bar | text
4362 POS ::= left | center | right
4363 FORM ::= (NUM . EXPR) | (OP EXPR ...)
4364 OP ::= + | -
4365
4366 The form `NUM' specifies a fractional width or height of the default
4367 frame font size. The form `(NUM)' specifies an absolute number of
4368 pixels. If a symbol is specified, its buffer-local variable binding
4369 is used. The `in', `mm', and `cm' units specifies the number of
4370 pixels per inch, milli-meter, and centi-meter, resp. The `width' and
4371 `height' units correspond to the width and height of the current face
4372 font. An image specification corresponds to the width or height of
4373 the image.
4374
4375 The `left-fringe', `right-fringe', `left-margin', `right-margin',
4376 `scroll-bar', and `text' elements specify to the width of the
4377 corresponding area of the window.
4378
4379 The `left', `center', and `right' positions can be used with :align-to
4380 to specify a position relative to the left edge, center, or right edge
4381 of the text area. One of the above window elements (except `text')
4382 can also be used with :align-to to specify that the position is
4383 relative to the left edge of the given area. Once the base offset for
4384 a relative position has been set (by the first occurrence of one of
4385 these symbols), further occurences of these symbols are interpreted as
4386 the width of the area.
4387
4388 For example, to align to the center of the left-margin, use
4389 :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin))
4390
4391 If no specific base offset is set for alignment, it is always relative
4392 to the left edge of the text area. For example, :align-to 0 in a
4393 header line aligns with the first text column in the text area.
4394
4395 The value of the form `(NUM . EXPR)' is the value of NUM multiplied by
4396 the value of the expression EXPR. For example, (2 . in) specifies a
4397 width of 2 inches, while (0.5 . IMAGE) specifies half the width (or
4398 height) of the specified image.
4399
4400 The form `(+ EXPR ...)' adds up the value of the expressions.
4401 The form `(- EXPR ...)' negates or subtracts the value of the expressions.
4402
4403 +++
4404 *** Normally, the cursor is displayed at the end of any overlay and
4405 text property string that may be present at the current window
4406 position. The cursor can now be placed on any character of such
4407 strings by giving that character a non-nil `cursor' text property.
4408
4409 +++
4410 *** The display space :width and :align-to text properties are now
4411 supported on text terminals.
4412
4413 +++
4414 *** Support for displaying image slices
4415
4416 **** New display property (slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT) can be used with
4417 an image property to display only a specific slice of the image.
4418
4419 **** Function `insert-image' has new optional fourth arg to
4420 specify image slice (X Y WIDTH HEIGHT).
4421
4422 **** New function `insert-sliced-image' inserts a given image as a
4423 specified number of evenly sized slices (rows x columns).
4424
4425 +++
4426 *** Images can now have an associated image map via the :map property.
4427
4428 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
4429 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
4430 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((X0 . Y0) . (X1 . Y1))) specifying the
4431 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
4432 A circle is a cons (circle . ((X0 . Y0) . R)) specifying the center
4433 and the radius of the circle; R can be a float or integer.
4434 A polygon is a cons (poly . [X0 Y0 X1 Y1 ...]) where each pair in the
4435 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
4436
4437 When the mouse pointer is above a hot-spot area of an image, the
4438 PLIST of that hot-spot is consulted; if it contains a `help-echo'
4439 property it defines a tool-tip for the hot-spot, and if it contains
4440 a `pointer' property, it defines the shape of the mouse cursor when
4441 it is over the hot-spot. See the variable `void-area-text-pointer'
4442 for possible pointer shapes.
4443
4444 When you click the mouse when the mouse pointer is over a hot-spot,
4445 an event is composed by combining the ID of the hot-spot with the
4446 mouse event, e.g. [area4 mouse-1] if the hot-spot's ID is `area4'.
4447
4448 ** Mouse pointer features:
4449
4450 +++ (lispref)
4451 ??? (man)
4452 *** The mouse pointer shape in void text areas (i.e. after the end of a
4453 line or below the last line in the buffer) of the text window is now
4454 controlled by the new variable `void-text-area-pointer'. The default
4455 is to use the `arrow' (non-text) pointer. Other choices are `text'
4456 (or nil), `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'.
4457
4458 +++
4459 *** The mouse pointer shape over an image can now be controlled by the
4460 :pointer image property.
4461
4462 +++
4463 *** The mouse pointer shape over ordinary text or images can now be
4464 controlled/overriden via the `pointer' text property.
4465
4466 ** Mouse event enhancements:
4467
4468 +++
4469 *** Mouse events for clicks on window fringes now specify `left-fringe'
4470 or `right-fringe' as the area.
4471
4472 +++
4473 *** All mouse events now include a buffer position regardless of where
4474 you clicked. For mouse clicks in window margins and fringes, this is
4475 a sensible buffer position corresponding to the surrounding text.
4476
4477 +++
4478 *** `posn-point' now returns buffer position for non-text area events.
4479
4480 +++
4481 *** Function `mouse-set-point' now works for events outside text area.
4482
4483 +++
4484 *** New function `posn-area' returns window area clicked on (nil means
4485 text area).
4486
4487 +++
4488 *** Mouse events include actual glyph column and row for all event types
4489 and all areas.
4490
4491 +++
4492 *** New function `posn-actual-col-row' returns the actual glyph coordinates
4493 of the mouse event position.
4494
4495 +++
4496 *** Mouse events can now indicate an image object clicked on.
4497
4498 +++
4499 *** Mouse events include relative X and Y pixel coordinates relative to
4500 the top left corner of the object (image or character) clicked on.
4501
4502 +++
4503 *** Mouse events include the pixel width and height of the object
4504 (image or character) clicked on.
4505
4506 +++
4507 *** New functions 'posn-object', 'posn-object-x-y', 'posn-object-width-height'.
4508
4509 These return the image or string object of a mouse click, the X and Y
4510 pixel coordinates relative to the top left corner of that object, and
4511 the total width and height of that object.
4512
4513 ** Text property and overlay changes:
4514
4515 +++
4516 *** Arguments for `remove-overlays' are now optional, so that you can
4517 remove all overlays in the buffer with just (remove-overlays).
4518
4519 +++
4520 *** New variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
4521
4522 This variable allows you to create alternative names for text
4523 properties. It works at the same level as `default-text-properties',
4524 although it applies to overlays as well. This variable was introduced
4525 to implement the `font-lock-face' property.
4526
4527 +++
4528 *** New function `get-char-property-and-overlay' accepts the same
4529 arguments as `get-char-property' and returns a cons whose car is the
4530 return value of `get-char-property' called with those arguments and
4531 whose cdr is the overlay in which the property was found, or nil if
4532 it was found as a text property or not found at all.
4533
4534 +++
4535 *** The new function `remove-list-of-text-properties'.
4536
4537 It is like `remove-text-properties' except that it takes a list of
4538 property names as argument rather than a property list.
4539
4540 ** Face changes
4541
4542 +++
4543 *** The new face attribute condition `min-colors' can be used to tailor
4544 the face color to the number of colors supported by a display, and
4545 define the foreground and background colors accordingly so that they
4546 look best on a terminal that supports at least this many colors. This
4547 is now the preferred method for defining default faces in a way that
4548 makes a good use of the capabilities of the display.
4549
4550 +++
4551 *** New function `display-supports-face-attributes-p' can be used to test
4552 whether a given set of face attributes is actually displayable.
4553
4554 A new predicate `supports' has also been added to the `defface' face
4555 specification language, which can be used to do this test for faces
4556 defined with `defface'.
4557
4558 ---
4559 *** The special treatment of faces whose names are of the form `fg:COLOR'
4560 or `bg:COLOR' has been removed. Lisp programs should use the
4561 `defface' facility for defining faces with specific colors, or use
4562 the feature of specifying the face attributes :foreground and :background
4563 directly in the `face' property instead of using a named face.
4564
4565 +++
4566 *** The first face specification element in a defface can specify
4567 `default' instead of frame classification. Then its attributes act as
4568 defaults that apply to all the subsequent cases (and can be overridden
4569 by them).
4570
4571 +++
4572 *** The variable `face-font-rescale-alist' specifies how much larger
4573 (or smaller) font we should use. For instance, if the value is
4574 '((SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN . 1.3)) and a face requests a font of 10
4575 point, we actually use a font of 13 point if the font matches
4576 SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN.
4577
4578 ---
4579 *** The function `face-differs-from-default-p' now truly checks
4580 whether the given face displays differently from the default face or
4581 not (previously it did only a very cursory check).
4582
4583 +++
4584 *** `face-attribute', `face-foreground', `face-background', `face-stipple'.
4585
4586 These now accept a new optional argument, INHERIT, which controls how
4587 face inheritance is used when determining the value of a face
4588 attribute.
4589
4590 +++
4591 *** New functions `face-attribute-relative-p' and `merge-face-attribute'
4592 help with handling relative face attributes.
4593
4594 +++
4595 *** The priority of faces in an :inherit attribute face list is reversed.
4596
4597 If a face contains an :inherit attribute with a list of faces, earlier
4598 faces in the list override later faces in the list; in previous
4599 releases of Emacs, the order was the opposite. This change was made
4600 so that :inherit face lists operate identically to face lists in text
4601 `face' properties.
4602
4603 ---
4604 *** `set-fontset-font', `fontset-info', `fontset-font' now operate on
4605 the default fontset if the argument NAME is nil..
4606
4607 ** Font-Lock changes:
4608
4609 +++
4610 *** New special text property `font-lock-face'.
4611
4612 This property acts like the `face' property, but it is controlled by
4613 M-x font-lock-mode. It is not, strictly speaking, a builtin text
4614 property. Instead, it is implemented inside font-core.el, using the
4615 new variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
4616
4617 +++
4618 *** font-lock can manage arbitrary text-properties beside `face'.
4619
4620 **** the FACENAME returned in `font-lock-keywords' can be a list of the
4621 form (face FACE PROP1 VAL1 PROP2 VAL2 ...) so you can set other
4622 properties than `face'.
4623
4624 **** `font-lock-extra-managed-props' can be set to make sure those
4625 extra properties are automatically cleaned up by font-lock.
4626
4627 ---
4628 *** jit-lock obeys a new text-property `jit-lock-defer-multiline'.
4629
4630 If a piece of text with that property gets contextually refontified
4631 (see `jit-lock-defer-contextually'), then all of that text will
4632 be refontified. This is useful when the syntax of a textual element
4633 depends on text several lines further down (and when `font-lock-multiline'
4634 is not appropriate to solve that problem). For example in Perl:
4635
4636 s{
4637 foo
4638 }{
4639 bar
4640 }e
4641
4642 Adding/removing the last `e' changes the `bar' from being a piece of
4643 text to being a piece of code, so you'd put a `jit-lock-defer-multiline'
4644 property over the second half of the command to force (deferred)
4645 refontification of `bar' whenever the `e' is added/removed.
4646
4647 ** Major mode mechanism changes:
4648
4649 +++
4650 *** `set-auto-mode' now gives the interpreter magic line (if present)
4651 precedence over the file name. Likewise an `<?xml' or `<!DOCTYPE'
4652 declaration will give the buffer XML or SGML mode, based on the new
4653 var `magic-mode-alist'.
4654
4655 +++
4656 *** Use the new function `run-mode-hooks' to run the major mode's mode hook.
4657
4658 +++
4659 *** All major mode functions should now run the new normal hook
4660 `after-change-major-mode-hook', at their very end, after the mode
4661 hooks. `run-mode-hooks' does this automatically.
4662
4663 ---
4664 *** If a major mode function has a non-nil `no-clone-indirect'
4665 property, `clone-indirect-buffer' signals an error if you use
4666 it in that buffer.
4667
4668 +++
4669 *** Major modes can define `eldoc-documentation-function'
4670 locally to provide Eldoc functionality by some method appropriate to
4671 the language.
4672
4673 +++
4674 *** `define-derived-mode' by default creates a new empty abbrev table.
4675 It does not copy abbrevs from the parent mode's abbrev table.
4676
4677 +++
4678 *** The new function `run-mode-hooks' and the new macro `delay-mode-hooks'
4679 are used by `define-derived-mode' to make sure the mode hook for the
4680 parent mode is run at the end of the child mode.
4681
4682 ** Minor mode changes:
4683
4684 +++
4685 *** `define-minor-mode' now accepts arbitrary additional keyword arguments
4686 and simply passes them to `defcustom', if applicable.
4687
4688 +++
4689 *** `minor-mode-list' now holds a list of minor mode commands.
4690
4691 +++
4692 *** `define-global-minor-mode'.
4693
4694 This is a new name for what was formerly called
4695 `easy-mmode-define-global-mode'. The old name remains as an alias.
4696
4697 ** Command loop changes:
4698
4699 +++
4700 *** The new function `called-interactively-p' does what many people
4701 have mistakenly believed `interactive-p' to do: it returns t if the
4702 calling function was called through `call-interactively'.
4703
4704 Only use this when you cannot solve the problem by adding a new
4705 INTERACTIVE argument to the command.
4706
4707 +++
4708 *** The function `commandp' takes an additional optional argument.
4709
4710 If it is non-nil, then `commandp' checks for a function that could be
4711 called with `call-interactively', and does not return t for keyboard
4712 macros.
4713
4714 +++
4715 *** When a command returns, the command loop moves point out from
4716 within invisible text, in the same way it moves out from within text
4717 covered by an image or composition property.
4718
4719 This makes it generally unnecessary to mark invisible text as intangible.
4720 This is particularly good because the intangible property often has
4721 unexpected side-effects since the property applies to everything
4722 (including `goto-char', ...) whereas this new code is only run after
4723 `post-command-hook' and thus does not care about intermediate states.
4724
4725 +++
4726 *** If a command sets `transient-mark-mode' to `only', that
4727 enables Transient Mark mode for the following command only.
4728 During that following command, the value of `transient-mark-mode'
4729 is `identity'. If it is still `identity' at the end of the command,
4730 the next return to the command loop changes to nil.
4731
4732 +++
4733 *** Both the variable and the function `disabled-command-hook' have
4734 been renamed to `disabled-command-function'. The variable
4735 `disabled-command-hook' has been kept as an obsolete alias.
4736
4737 +++
4738 *** `emacsserver' now runs `pre-command-hook' and `post-command-hook'
4739 when it receives a request from emacsclient.
4740
4741 ** Lisp file loading changes:
4742
4743 +++
4744 *** `load-history' can now have elements of the form (t . FUNNAME),
4745 which means FUNNAME was previously defined as an autoload (before the
4746 current file redefined it).
4747
4748 +++
4749 *** `load-history' now records (defun . FUNNAME) when a function is
4750 defined. For a variable, it records just the variable name.
4751
4752 +++
4753 *** The function `symbol-file' can now search specifically for function,
4754 variable or face definitions.
4755
4756 +++
4757 *** `provide' and `featurep' now accept an optional second argument
4758 to test/provide subfeatures. Also `provide' now checks `after-load-alist'
4759 and runs any code associated with the provided feature.
4760
4761 ---
4762 *** The variable `recursive-load-depth-limit' has been deleted.
4763 Emacs now signals an error if the same file is loaded with more
4764 than 3 levels of nesting.
4765
4766 +++
4767 ** Byte compiler changes:
4768
4769 *** The byte compiler now displays the actual line and character
4770 position of errors, where possible. Additionally, the form of its
4771 warning and error messages have been brought into line with GNU standards
4772 for these. As a result, you can use next-error and friends on the
4773 compilation output buffer.
4774
4775 *** The new macro `with-no-warnings' suppresses all compiler warnings
4776 inside its body. In terms of execution, it is equivalent to `progn'.
4777
4778 *** You can avoid warnings for possibly-undefined symbols with a
4779 simple convention that the compiler understands. (This is mostly
4780 useful in code meant to be portable to different Emacs versions.)
4781 Write forms like the following, or code that macroexpands into such
4782 forms:
4783
4784 (if (fboundp 'foo) <then> <else>)
4785 (if (boundp 'foo) <then> <else)
4786
4787 In the first case, using `foo' as a function inside the <then> form
4788 won't produce a warning if it's not defined as a function, and in the
4789 second case, using `foo' as a variable won't produce a warning if it's
4790 unbound. The test must be in exactly one of the above forms (after
4791 macro expansion), but such tests can be nested. Note that `when' and
4792 `unless' expand to `if', but `cond' doesn't.
4793
4794 *** `(featurep 'xemacs)' is treated by the compiler as nil. This
4795 helps to avoid noisy compiler warnings in code meant to run under both
4796 Emacs and XEmacs and can sometimes make the result significantly more
4797 efficient. Since byte code from recent versions of XEmacs won't
4798 generally run in Emacs and vice versa, this optimization doesn't lose
4799 you anything.
4800
4801 *** The local variable `no-byte-compile' in Lisp files is now obeyed.
4802
4803 ---
4804 *** When a Lisp file uses CL functions at run-time, compiling the file
4805 now issues warnings about these calls, unless the file performs
4806 (require 'cl) when loaded.
4807
4808 ** Frame operations:
4809
4810 +++
4811 *** New functions `frame-current-scroll-bars' and `window-current-scroll-bars'.
4812
4813 These functions return the current locations of the vertical and
4814 horizontal scroll bars in a frame or window.
4815
4816 +++
4817 *** The new function `modify-all-frames-parameters' modifies parameters
4818 for all (existing and future) frames.
4819
4820 +++
4821 *** The new frame parameter `tty-color-mode' specifies the mode to use
4822 for color support on character terminal frames. Its value can be a
4823 number of colors to support, or a symbol. See the Emacs Lisp
4824 Reference manual for more detailed documentation.
4825
4826 +++
4827 *** When using non-toolkit scroll bars with the default width,
4828 the `scroll-bar-width' frame parameter value is nil.
4829
4830 ** Mule changes:
4831
4832 +++
4833 *** Already true in Emacs 21.1, but not emphasized clearly enough:
4834
4835 Multibyte buffers can now faithfully record all 256 character codes
4836 from 0 to 255. As a result, most of the past reasons to use unibyte
4837 buffers no longer exist. We only know of three reasons to use them
4838 now:
4839
4840 1. If you prefer to use unibyte text all of the time.
4841
4842 2. For reading files into temporary buffers, when you want to avoid
4843 the time it takes to convert the format.
4844
4845 3. For binary files where format conversion would be pointless and
4846 wasteful.
4847
4848 ---
4849 *** `set-buffer-file-coding-system' now takes an additional argument,
4850 NOMODIFY. If it is non-nil, it means don't mark the buffer modified.
4851
4852 +++
4853 *** The new variable `auto-coding-functions' lets you specify functions
4854 to examine a file being visited and deduce the proper coding system
4855 for it. (If the coding system is detected incorrectly for a specific
4856 file, you can put a `coding:' tags to override it.)
4857
4858 ---
4859 *** The new function `merge-coding-systems' fills in unspecified aspects
4860 of one coding system from another coding system.
4861
4862 ---
4863 *** New coding system property `mime-text-unsuitable' indicates that
4864 the coding system's `mime-charset' is not suitable for MIME text
4865 parts, e.g. utf-16.
4866
4867 +++
4868 *** New function `decode-coding-inserted-region' decodes a region as if
4869 it is read from a file without decoding.
4870
4871 ---
4872 *** New CCL functions `lookup-character' and `lookup-integer' access
4873 hash tables defined by the Lisp function `define-translation-hash-table'.
4874
4875 ---
4876 *** New function `quail-find-key' returns a list of keys to type in the
4877 current input method to input a character.
4878
4879 ** Mode line changes:
4880
4881 +++
4882 *** New function `format-mode-line'.
4883
4884 This returns the mode line or header line of the selected (or a
4885 specified) window as a string with or without text properties.
4886
4887 +++
4888 *** The new mode-line construct `(:propertize ELT PROPS...)' can be
4889 used to add text properties to mode-line elements.
4890
4891 +++
4892 *** The new `%i' and `%I' constructs for `mode-line-format' can be used
4893 to display the size of the accessible part of the buffer on the mode
4894 line.
4895
4896 +++
4897 *** Mouse-face on mode-line (and header-line) is now supported.
4898
4899 ** Menu manipulation changes:
4900
4901 ---
4902 *** To manipulate the File menu using easy-menu, you must specify the
4903 proper name "file". In previous Emacs versions, you had to specify
4904 "files", even though the menu item itself was changed to say "File"
4905 several versions ago.
4906
4907 ---
4908 *** The dummy function keys made by easy-menu are now always lower case.
4909 If you specify the menu item name "Ada", for instance, it uses `ada'
4910 as the "key" bound by that key binding.
4911
4912 This is relevant only if Lisp code looks for the bindings that were
4913 made with easy-menu.
4914
4915 ---
4916 *** `easy-menu-define' now allows you to use nil for the symbol name
4917 if you don't need to give the menu a name. If you install the menu
4918 into other keymaps right away (MAPS is non-nil), it usually doesn't
4919 need to have a name.
4920
4921 ** Operating system access:
4922
4923 +++
4924 *** The new primitive `get-internal-run-time' returns the processor
4925 run time used by Emacs since start-up.
4926
4927 +++
4928 *** Functions `user-uid' and `user-real-uid' now return floats if the
4929 user UID doesn't fit in a Lisp integer. Function `user-full-name'
4930 accepts a float as UID parameter.
4931
4932 +++
4933 *** New function `locale-info' accesses locale information.
4934
4935 ---
4936 *** On MS Windows, locale-coding-system is used to interact with the OS.
4937 The Windows specific variable w32-system-coding-system, which was
4938 formerly used for that purpose is now an alias for locale-coding-system.
4939
4940 ---
4941 *** New function `redirect-debugging-output' can be used to redirect
4942 debugging output on the stderr file handle to a file.
4943
4944 ** Miscellaneous:
4945
4946 +++
4947 *** A number of hooks have been renamed to better follow the conventions:
4948
4949 `find-file-hooks' to `find-file-hook',
4950 `find-file-not-found-hooks' to `find-file-not-found-functions',
4951 `write-file-hooks' to `write-file-functions',
4952 `write-contents-hooks' to `write-contents-functions',
4953 `x-lost-selection-hooks' to `x-lost-selection-functions',
4954 `x-sent-selection-hooks' to `x-sent-selection-functions',
4955 `delete-frame-hook' to `delete-frame-functions'.
4956
4957 In each case the old name remains as an alias for the moment.
4958
4959 +++
4960 *** local-write-file-hooks is marked obsolete
4961
4962 Use the LOCAL arg of `add-hook'.
4963
4964 ---
4965 *** New function `x-send-client-message' sends a client message when
4966 running under X.
4967
4968 ** GC changes:
4969
4970 +++
4971 *** New variables `gc-elapsed' and `gcs-done' provide extra information
4972 on garbage collection.
4973
4974 +++
4975 *** The normal hook `post-gc-hook' is run at the end of garbage collection.
4976
4977 The hook is run with GC inhibited, so use it with care.
4978 \f
4979 * New Packages for Lisp Programming in Emacs 22.1
4980
4981 +++
4982 ** The new library button.el implements simple and fast `clickable
4983 buttons' in emacs buffers. Buttons are much lighter-weight than the
4984 `widgets' implemented by widget.el, and can be used by lisp code that
4985 doesn't require the full power of widgets. Emacs uses buttons for
4986 such things as help and apropos buffers.
4987
4988 ---
4989 ** The new library tree-widget.el provides a widget to display a set
4990 of hierarchical data as an outline. For example, the tree-widget is
4991 well suited to display a hierarchy of directories and files.
4992
4993 ** The new library bindat.el provides functions to unpack and pack
4994 binary data structures, such as network packets, to and from Lisp
4995 data structures.
4996
4997 ---
4998 ** master-mode.el implements a minor mode for scrolling a slave
4999 buffer without leaving your current buffer, the master buffer.
5000
5001 It can be used by sql.el, for example: the SQL buffer is the master
5002 and its SQLi buffer is the slave. This allows you to scroll the SQLi
5003 buffer containing the output from the SQL buffer containing the
5004 commands.
5005
5006 This is how to use sql.el and master.el together: the variable
5007 sql-buffer contains the slave buffer. It is a local variable in the
5008 SQL buffer.
5009
5010 (add-hook 'sql-mode-hook
5011 (function (lambda ()
5012 (master-mode t)
5013 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
5014 (add-hook 'sql-set-sqli-hook
5015 (function (lambda ()
5016 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
5017
5018 +++
5019 ** The new library benchmark.el does timing measurements on Lisp code.
5020
5021 This includes measuring garbage collection time.
5022
5023 +++
5024 ** The new library testcover.el does test coverage checking.
5025
5026 This is so you can tell whether you've tested all paths in your Lisp
5027 code. It works with edebug.
5028
5029 The function `testcover-start' instruments all functions in a given
5030 file. Then test your code. The function `testcover-mark-all' adds
5031 overlay "splotches" to the Lisp file's buffer to show where coverage
5032 is lacking. The command `testcover-next-mark' (bind it to a key!)
5033 will move point forward to the next spot that has a splotch.
5034
5035 Normally, a red splotch indicates the form was never completely
5036 evaluated; a brown splotch means it always evaluated to the same
5037 value. The red splotches are skipped for forms that can't possibly
5038 complete their evaluation, such as `error'. The brown splotches are
5039 skipped for forms that are expected to always evaluate to the same
5040 value, such as (setq x 14).
5041
5042 For difficult cases, you can add do-nothing macros to your code to
5043 help out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a
5044 red splotch. It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does
5045 return. The macro `1value' suppresses a brown splotch for its argument.
5046 This macro is a no-op except during test-coverage -- then it signals
5047 an error if the argument actually returns differing values.
5048 \f
5049 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
5050
5051 ** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
5052 been added.
5053
5054 \f
5055 * Changes in Emacs 21.3
5056
5057 ** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
5058 with Custom.
5059
5060 ** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
5061 as mule-utf-8.
5062
5063 ** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
5064 in UTF-8 locales).
5065
5066 ** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
5067 different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
5068 Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
5069 and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
5070 between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
5071 (e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
5072 `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
5073 `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
5074 it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
5075 By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
5076
5077 ** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
5078 `selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
5079
5080 If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
5081 compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
5082 compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
5083 text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behavior is actually
5084 contrary to the compound text specification.
5085
5086 \f
5087 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
5088
5089 ** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
5090
5091 ** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
5092
5093 \f
5094 * Changes in Emacs 21.2
5095
5096 ** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
5097
5098 X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
5099 compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
5100 list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
5101 selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
5102 compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
5103
5104 ** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
5105 were changed.
5106
5107 ** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
5108 now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
5109
5110 ** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
5111 initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
5112 instead of using default-major-mode.
5113
5114 ** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
5115 like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
5116 as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
5117 (the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
5118 visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
5119 is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
5120 to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
5121
5122 This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
5123 NEWS.
5124
5125 \f
5126 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
5127
5128 ** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
5129 have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
5130 and the latter now controls scrolling down.
5131
5132 ** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
5133 be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
5134
5135 \f
5136 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
5137
5138 See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
5139 fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
5140 charsets in this release.
5141
5142 ** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
5143
5144 ** Support for LynxOS has been added.
5145
5146 ** There are new configure options associated with the support for
5147 images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
5148 to list them.
5149
5150 ** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
5151 support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
5152 maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
5153 build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
5154 necessary changes to unexec.
5155
5156 ** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
5157 Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
5158
5159 ** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
5160 Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
5161
5162 ** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
5163 the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
5164
5165 ** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
5166 all of the new display features described below. The port currently
5167 lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
5168 "Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
5169 description of aspects specific to the Mac.
5170
5171 ** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
5172 new display features described below.
5173
5174 \f
5175 * Changes in Emacs 21.1
5176
5177 ** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
5178
5179 The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
5180 Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
5181 oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
5182 of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
5183 the text.
5184
5185 ** Emacs has a new face implementation.
5186
5187 The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
5188 font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
5189 height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
5190 These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
5191 specify a font.
5192
5193 Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
5194 These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
5195 under Lisp changes, below.
5196
5197 ** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
5198
5199 Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
5200 Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
5201 the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
5202 italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
5203 Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
5204 attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
5205 on terminals.
5206
5207 The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
5208 supported on character terminals.
5209
5210 Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
5211 the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
5212 same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
5213 a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
5214
5215 ** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
5216
5217 ** Sound support
5218
5219 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
5220 driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
5221 supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
5222 You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
5223 sound support.
5224
5225 ** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
5226
5227 If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
5228 longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
5229 is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
5230 minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
5231
5232 - User option: max-mini-window-height
5233
5234 Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
5235 fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
5236 specifies a number of lines.
5237
5238 Default is 0.25.
5239
5240 - User option: resize-mini-windows
5241
5242 How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
5243 resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
5244 grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
5245 again.
5246
5247 Default is `grow-only'.
5248
5249 ** LessTif support.
5250
5251 Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
5252 <http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
5253
5254 ** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
5255
5256 When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
5257 from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
5258 non-nil.
5259
5260 ** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
5261
5262 When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
5263 now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
5264 file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
5265
5266 ** Toolkit scroll bars.
5267
5268 Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
5269 LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
5270 configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
5271 bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
5272 bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
5273 Emacs.
5274
5275 When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
5276 Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
5277 Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
5278 Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
5279 define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
5280 `s/freebsd.h' as an example.
5281
5282 Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
5283 a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
5284 directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
5285 different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
5286 system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
5287 add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
5288
5289 The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
5290 `float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
5291 This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
5292 imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
5293 Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
5294
5295 ** Tool bar support.
5296
5297 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
5298 of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
5299 changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
5300 displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
5301 if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
5302 icons will be used.
5303
5304 To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
5305 for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
5306
5307 ** Tooltips.
5308
5309 Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
5310 mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
5311 turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
5312
5313 Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
5314 variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
5315 the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
5316 tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
5317
5318 ** Automatic Hscrolling
5319
5320 Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
5321 `automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
5322 customized.
5323
5324 If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
5325 scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
5326 for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
5327 the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
5328 to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
5329
5330 ** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
5331 of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
5332 solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
5333 `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
5334 cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
5335 non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
5336
5337 ** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
5338 truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
5339 foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
5340 customizing face `fringe'.
5341
5342 ** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
5343 You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
5344 In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
5345 appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
5346 occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
5347 the window to be partially obscured.)
5348
5349 The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
5350 versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
5351 However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
5352 ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
5353
5354 ** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
5355
5356 Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
5357 systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
5358 mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
5359 mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
5360 displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
5361 have enabled one.
5362
5363 Currently, the following actions have been defined:
5364
5365 - Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
5366
5367 - Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
5368
5369 - Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
5370 `*') toggles the status.
5371
5372 - Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
5373
5374 ** Hourglass pointer
5375
5376 Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
5377 turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
5378
5379 ** Blinking cursor
5380
5381 M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
5382 terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
5383 and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
5384 the group `cursor'.
5385
5386 ** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
5387
5388 This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
5389 generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
5390 See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
5391 details.
5392
5393 Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
5394 have to do anything to activate it.
5395
5396 ** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
5397
5398 The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
5399 determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
5400
5401 On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
5402 according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
5403 key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
5404 option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
5405 delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
5406 keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
5407 keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
5408 set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
5409
5410 If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
5411 a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
5412 Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
5413 `keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
5414 the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
5415 terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
5416
5417 Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
5418 to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
5419
5420 ** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
5421 changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
5422 buffer by default.
5423
5424 ** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
5425 current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
5426 beginning and end of the buffer.
5427
5428 ** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
5429 recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
5430 signaled.
5431
5432 ** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
5433 file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
5434
5435 ** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
5436 compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
5437 this behavior.
5438
5439 The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
5440 compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
5441 Emacs dump core.
5442
5443 ** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
5444
5445 When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
5446 widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
5447 Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
5448
5449 ** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
5450 more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
5451 now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
5452
5453 ** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
5454 using that menu.
5455
5456 ** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
5457
5458 When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
5459 whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
5460 defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
5461 highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
5462 displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
5463 whitespace.
5464
5465 ** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
5466 all frames except the selected one.
5467
5468 ** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
5469 let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
5470
5471 ** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
5472 header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
5473 so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
5474 This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
5475 `Info-use-header-line'.
5476
5477 ** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
5478 have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
5479 `de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
5480
5481 ** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
5482
5483 ** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
5484 `dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
5485 `fr-drdref.tex'.
5486
5487 ** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
5488 displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
5489 menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
5490 menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
5491
5492 ** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
5493
5494 You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
5495 because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
5496 use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
5497 `~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
5498
5499 ** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
5500 point in a pop-up window.
5501
5502 ** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
5503 under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
5504 customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
5505
5506 The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
5507 determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
5508
5509 ** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
5510 sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
5511 (On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
5512 You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
5513
5514 ** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
5515
5516 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
5517 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
5518
5519 ** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
5520 trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
5521 this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
5522
5523 ** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
5524 be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
5525 non-nil.
5526
5527 ** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
5528 set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
5529 file that is already visited under a different name.
5530
5531 ** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
5532 nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
5533
5534 ** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
5535 and displays information about that.
5536
5537 ** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
5538 expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
5539
5540 This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
5541 determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
5542 mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
5543 interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
5544 regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
5545 associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
5546
5547 ** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
5548 suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
5549
5550 ** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
5551 buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
5552 contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
5553 by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
5554 insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
5555 the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
5556 Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
5557
5558 ** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
5559 been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
5560
5561 ** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
5562 system for keyboard input.
5563
5564 ** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
5565 coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
5566 escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
5567 such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
5568 recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
5569 always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
5570 read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
5571 (`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
5572 RET C-x C-f filename RET.
5573
5574 ** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
5575 environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
5576
5577 ** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
5578 displays all characters in that character set.
5579
5580 ** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
5581 coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
5582
5583 ** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
5584 and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
5585 LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
5586
5587 ** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
5588 Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
5589 8859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
5590 GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
5591 8859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
5592 There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
5593 and Polish `slash'.
5594
5595 ** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
5596 These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
5597 of the tutorial.
5598
5599 ** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
5600 function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
5601 Lisp Coding Convention".
5602
5603 new command old-binding
5604 --- ------- -----------
5605 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
5606 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
5607 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
5608
5609 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
5610 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
5611 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
5612
5613 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
5614 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
5615 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
5616 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
5617 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
5618 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
5619
5620 ** There are new Leim input methods.
5621 New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
5622 "greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
5623 package.
5624
5625 ** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
5626 rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
5627 typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
5628 "=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
5629 "`", you must type "=q".
5630
5631 ** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
5632 8859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
5633 more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
5634 empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
5635 window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
5636 on.
5637
5638 ** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
5639 on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
5640 defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
5641 commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
5642
5643 ** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
5644 `display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
5645 indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
5646 indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
5647
5648 ** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
5649 on the display using several methods
5650
5651 - By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
5652 a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
5653 be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
5654
5655 - By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
5656 equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
5657
5658 - By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
5659
5660 - By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
5661 the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
5662
5663 ** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
5664 an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
5665 command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
5666 does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
5667
5668 ** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
5669 `make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
5670 typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
5671
5672 ** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
5673 characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
5674
5675 ** New X resources recognized
5676
5677 *** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
5678 whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
5679 is useful for debugging X problems.
5680
5681 Example:
5682
5683 emacs.synchronous: true
5684
5685 *** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
5686 visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
5687 the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
5688 and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
5689 visual class names are
5690
5691 TrueColor
5692 PseudoColor
5693 DirectColor
5694 StaticColor
5695 GrayScale
5696 StaticGray
5697
5698 Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
5699 `pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
5700 meaning.
5701
5702 The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
5703 supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
5704 `visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
5705 visual.
5706
5707 Example:
5708
5709 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
5710
5711 *** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
5712 specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
5713 default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
5714 resource values are `true' or `on'.
5715
5716 Example:
5717
5718 emacs.privateColormap: true
5719
5720 ** Faces and frame parameters.
5721
5722 There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
5723 Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
5724 `scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
5725 `scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
5726 sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
5727 for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
5728 parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
5729
5730 Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
5731 `default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
5732 `foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
5733 `default' face and vice versa.
5734
5735 ** New face `menu'.
5736
5737 The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
5738
5739 ** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
5740
5741 The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
5742 colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
5743 correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
5744 the screen gamma of a frame's display.
5745
5746 PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
5747 in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
5748 color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
5749
5750 The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
5751 `ScreenGamma'.
5752
5753 ** Tabs and variable-width text.
5754
5755 Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
5756 defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
5757 independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
5758 Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
5759
5760 ** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
5761
5762 *** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
5763
5764 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
5765
5766 The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
5767 LessTif/Motif one.
5768
5769 *** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
5770 LessTif and Motif.
5771
5772 ** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
5773
5774 As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
5775 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
5776 `x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
5777
5778 ** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
5779 bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
5780
5781 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
5782 `indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
5783 variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
5784
5785 ** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
5786
5787 When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
5788 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
5789 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
5790 fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
5791
5792 When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
5793 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
5794 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
5795 fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
5796
5797 ** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
5798 M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
5799 M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
5800 buffers.
5801
5802 ** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
5803
5804 ** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
5805 abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
5806 `directory-abbrev-alist'.
5807
5808 ** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
5809 the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
5810 forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
5811 value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
5812 users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
5813 even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
5814
5815 The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
5816
5817 ** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
5818 notably at the end of lines.
5819
5820 All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
5821 spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
5822
5823 ** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
5824
5825 ** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
5826 but inserts text instead of replacing it.
5827
5828 ** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
5829 query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
5830 after each match to get the replacement text.
5831
5832 ** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
5833 you edit the replacement string.
5834
5835 ** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
5836 (if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
5837 in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
5838
5839 ** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
5840
5841 ** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
5842 to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
5843
5844 ** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
5845 the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
5846 MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
5847 displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
5848
5849 --
5850 ** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
5851 read mail from the menu etc.
5852
5853 ** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
5854 This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
5855 MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
5856 before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
5857
5858 ** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
5859 MS-DOS version of Emacs.
5860
5861 ** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
5862 of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
5863 This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
5864 correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
5865 but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
5866 of Emacs.
5867
5868 ** Customize changes
5869
5870 *** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
5871 `State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
5872 M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
5873 customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
5874 earlier versions of Emacs.
5875
5876 *** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
5877 Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
5878 default).
5879
5880 *** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
5881 does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
5882 file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
5883 wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
5884 file.
5885
5886 ** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
5887 does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
5888 avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
5889 already in your init file.
5890
5891 ** New features in evaluation commands
5892
5893 *** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
5894 modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
5895 print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
5896 customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
5897 eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
5898
5899 The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
5900 respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
5901 the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
5902 the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
5903 printed).
5904
5905 <RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
5906 printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
5907
5908 The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
5909 during evaluation produces a backtrace.
5910
5911 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
5912 code when called with a prefix argument.
5913
5914 ** CC mode changes.
5915
5916 Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
5917 current user setups (although it's believed that these
5918 incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
5919 However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
5920 back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
5921 compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
5922 release.
5923
5924 *** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
5925 CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
5926 is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
5927 confusion.
5928
5929 However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
5930 default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
5931 java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
5932 notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
5933
5934 *** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
5935 Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
5936
5937 space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
5938 parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
5939
5940 compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
5941 parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
5942 It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
5943 style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
5944
5945 *** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
5946 Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
5947 "electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
5948 earlier statement. An example:
5949
5950 for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
5951 if (a[i])
5952 res += a[i]->offset;
5953 else
5954
5955 Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
5956 continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
5957 the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
5958 possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
5959 the preceding "if".
5960
5961 CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
5962 by default.
5963
5964 *** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
5965 Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
5966 meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
5967 documentation or other natural language text.
5968
5969 The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
5970 contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
5971 the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
5972 strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
5973 to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
5974 commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
5975 sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
5976
5977 *** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
5978 Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
5979 source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
5980 comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
5981
5982 *** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
5983 When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
5984 line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
5985 change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
5986 Pike mode only.
5987
5988 *** Better handling of syntactic errors.
5989 The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
5990 improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
5991 stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
5992 following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
5993 matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
5994 indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
5995 is reported afterwards.
5996
5997 *** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
5998 A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
5999 returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
6000
6001 *** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
6002 Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
6003 on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
6004 can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
6005 code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
6006 modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
6007 groundwork.
6008
6009 *** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
6010 This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
6011 of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
6012 non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
6013 want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
6014 have to bother.
6015
6016 Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
6017 situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
6018 and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
6019 If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
6020 the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
6021 by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
6022
6023 *** New initialization procedure for the style system.
6024 When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
6025 variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
6026 take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
6027 is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
6028 settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
6029 possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
6030 Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
6031
6032 By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
6033 special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
6034 the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
6035 of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
6036 above.
6037
6038 Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
6039 when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
6040 function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
6041 call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
6042 then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
6043 values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
6044 only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
6045 function documentation for more info.
6046
6047 The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
6048 especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
6049 with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
6050 intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
6051 such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
6052 is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
6053 configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
6054 global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
6055
6056 (Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
6057
6058 **** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
6059 This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
6060
6061 This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
6062 variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
6063 completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
6064 the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
6065 empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
6066 style system.
6067
6068 **** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
6069 In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
6070 c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
6071 as far as possible.
6072
6073 *** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
6074 CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
6075 surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
6076 chapter about this in the manual.
6077
6078 **** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
6079 The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
6080 recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
6081 primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
6082 adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
6083
6084 **** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
6085 This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
6086 c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
6087
6088 **** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
6089 This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
6090
6091 It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
6092 Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
6093 A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
6094 inside CC Mode.
6095
6096 Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
6097 causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
6098 the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
6099 available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
6100 cc-mode/).
6101
6102 **** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
6103 `c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
6104 enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
6105 function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
6106 they were before the filling.
6107
6108 **** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
6109 The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
6110 specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
6111 literals.
6112
6113 **** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
6114 It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
6115 prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
6116 you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
6117 this function.
6118
6119 *** Fixes to IDL mode.
6120 It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
6121 to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
6122 struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
6123 Thanks to Eric Eide.
6124
6125 *** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
6126 It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
6127 opening braces hangs and when they don't.
6128
6129 **** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
6130
6131 *** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
6132 See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
6133 better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
6134 and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
6135
6136 *** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
6137 previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
6138 the column specified by comment-column.
6139
6140 *** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
6141 In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
6142 is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
6143 prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
6144 contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
6145 don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
6146
6147 *** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
6148 instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
6149 arguments.
6150
6151 *** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
6152
6153 *** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
6154 c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
6155 c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
6156 variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
6157 Provan).
6158
6159 *** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
6160
6161 ** Dired changes
6162
6163 *** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
6164 command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
6165 is, delete only empty directories.
6166
6167 *** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
6168 command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
6169 copy directories recursively.
6170
6171 *** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
6172 in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
6173 the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
6174
6175 *** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
6176 replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
6177 directory.
6178
6179 *** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
6180 a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
6181 This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
6182 will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
6183 accurate or inaccurate as it is.
6184
6185 *** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
6186 from ls switches.
6187
6188 *** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
6189 of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
6190 which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
6191 source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
6192
6193 ** Gnus changes.
6194
6195 The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
6196 four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
6197 internationalization and mail-fetching.
6198
6199 *** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
6200 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
6201
6202 If you used procmail like in
6203
6204 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
6205 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
6206 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
6207 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
6208
6209 this now has changed to
6210
6211 (setq mail-sources
6212 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
6213 :suffix ".in")))
6214
6215 More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
6216 Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
6217
6218 *** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
6219 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
6220 Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
6221 longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
6222
6223 The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
6224 use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
6225 installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
6226
6227 *** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
6228 parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
6229 are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
6230 now just a compatibility layer.
6231
6232 *** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
6233 Gnus facilities.
6234
6235 *** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
6236 called to position point.
6237
6238 *** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
6239 summary buffers and NOV files.
6240
6241 *** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
6242 of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
6243
6244 *** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
6245 subtly different manner.
6246
6247 *** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
6248 and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
6249 ever-changing layouts.
6250
6251 *** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
6252
6253 *** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
6254
6255 ** Changes in Texinfo mode.
6256
6257 *** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
6258 macros
6259
6260 Key binding Macro
6261 -------------------------
6262 C-c C-c C-s @strong
6263 C-c C-c C-e @emph
6264 C-c C-c u @uref
6265 C-c C-c q @quotation
6266 C-c C-c m @email
6267 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
6268 M-RET @item
6269
6270 *** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
6271
6272 ** Changes in Outline mode.
6273
6274 There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
6275 `outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
6276 the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
6277
6278 ** Changes to Emacs Server
6279
6280 *** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
6281 with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
6282 are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
6283 Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
6284 buffers to kill, as before.
6285
6286 Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
6287 i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
6288 this way.
6289
6290 ** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
6291 of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
6292
6293 ** Changes to Show Paren mode.
6294
6295 *** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
6296 The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
6297 use. Default is 1000.
6298
6299 ** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
6300 groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
6301
6302 ** Changes to hideshow.el
6303
6304 *** Generalized block selection and traversal
6305
6306 A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
6307 and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
6308 serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
6309 See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
6310
6311 *** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
6312 hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
6313 be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
6314 the open block.
6315
6316 *** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
6317 function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
6318 the normal block-hiding function.
6319
6320 *** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
6321
6322 *** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
6323 roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
6324 for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
6325 for `hs-minor-mode'.
6326
6327 *** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
6328 hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
6329
6330 ** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
6331
6332 *** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
6333 an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
6334 log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
6335
6336 **** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
6337 current buffer.
6338
6339 *** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
6340 in a log file.
6341
6342 *** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
6343 entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
6344 Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
6345 version number is performed based on regular expressions from
6346 `change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
6347 Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
6348
6349 *** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
6350
6351 ** Changes to cmuscheme
6352
6353 *** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
6354 `cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
6355
6356 ** Changes in Font Lock
6357
6358 *** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
6359 font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
6360
6361 *** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
6362 set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
6363
6364 *** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
6365 the face used for each string/comment.
6366
6367 *** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
6368 Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
6369
6370 ** Changes to Shell mode
6371
6372 *** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
6373 to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
6374 non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
6375 prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
6376
6377 ** Comint (subshell) changes
6378
6379 These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
6380 include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
6381
6382 *** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
6383 Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
6384 BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
6385 beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
6386 respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
6387 the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
6388
6389 *** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
6390 to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
6391 parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
6392 user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
6393 this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
6394 respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
6395 feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
6396 `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
6397
6398 *** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
6399 and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
6400
6401 *** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
6402 buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
6403 buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
6404
6405 The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
6406 M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
6407 the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
6408
6409 *** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
6410 and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
6411 see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
6412
6413 *** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
6414 saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
6415 argument, it appends to the file.
6416
6417 *** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
6418 (usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
6419 compatibility.
6420
6421 *** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
6422 ring (history).
6423
6424 *** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
6425 identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
6426 strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
6427
6428 ** Changes to Rmail mode
6429
6430 *** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
6431 set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
6432 receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
6433 recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
6434 `user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
6435 as correspondent.
6436
6437 Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
6438 mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
6439 regexp matching your mail addresses.
6440
6441 *** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
6442 to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
6443 Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
6444 with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
6445 for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
6446
6447 *** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
6448 like `j'.
6449
6450 *** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
6451 specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
6452 digest message.
6453
6454 *** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
6455 in which folder to put messages automatically.
6456
6457 *** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
6458 with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
6459 due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
6460
6461 ** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
6462 an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
6463
6464 ** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
6465 use the -f option when sending mail.
6466
6467 ** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
6468 current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
6469 the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
6470 This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
6471 by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
6472 displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
6473
6474 If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
6475 other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
6476 `rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
6477
6478 ** Changes to TeX mode
6479
6480 *** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
6481 `latex-mode'.
6482
6483 *** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
6484
6485 *** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
6486
6487 *** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
6488
6489 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
6490
6491 *** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
6492 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
6493 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
6494 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
6495 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
6496 can be edited from that buffer.
6497
6498 *** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
6499 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
6500 `A' to use all marked entries).
6501
6502 *** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
6503 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
6504
6505 *** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
6506 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
6507 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
6508 been cited.
6509
6510 ** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
6511 The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
6512 semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
6513 in column 1 are always made leaves.
6514
6515 ** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
6516 has the following new features:
6517
6518 *** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
6519 may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
6520 to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
6521 time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
6522
6523 *** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
6524 feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
6525 file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
6526 compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
6527 pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
6528 defaults to 1.
6529
6530 ** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
6531 file names.
6532
6533 ** Ispell changes
6534
6535 *** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
6536 transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
6537 spell-checks the current buffer.
6538
6539 *** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
6540 added.
6541
6542 *** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
6543 correction is made and re-checked.
6544
6545 *** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
6546
6547 *** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
6548 cases.
6549
6550 *** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
6551 on syntax errors.
6552
6553 *** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
6554 end of the buffer.
6555
6556 *** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
6557
6558 ** Makefile mode changes
6559
6560 *** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
6561
6562 *** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
6563 Fontlock mode is active.
6564
6565 ** Isearch changes
6566
6567 *** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
6568 so that searches can be resumed.
6569
6570 *** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
6571 respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
6572 that started the search.
6573
6574 *** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
6575 selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
6576
6577 *** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
6578
6579 Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
6580 `isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
6581 search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
6582 before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
6583 highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
6584 `secondary-selection'.
6585
6586 The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
6587 will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
6588 Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
6589 using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
6590 usual snappy response.
6591
6592 If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
6593 matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
6594 set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
6595 isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
6596
6597 ** VC Changes
6598
6599 VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
6600 easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
6601 Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
6602 to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
6603 changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
6604 `vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
6605 version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
6606 each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
6607 file is registered in that backend.
6608
6609 When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
6610 backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
6611 directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
6612 master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
6613 the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
6614 As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
6615
6616 The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
6617 still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
6618 RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
6619 vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
6620 where it doesn't make sense.)
6621
6622 The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
6623 obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
6624 `CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
6625
6626 *** General Changes
6627
6628 The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
6629 checks are always done now.
6630
6631 VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
6632 operations.
6633
6634 `vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
6635 `vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
6636 `vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
6637
6638 The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
6639 first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
6640 current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
6641 the working file (``merge news'').
6642
6643 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
6644 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
6645 downwards.
6646
6647 *** Multiple Backends
6648
6649 VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
6650 useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
6651 repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
6652 commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
6653 local RCS archives.
6654
6655 To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
6656 should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
6657 backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
6658 `vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
6659
6660 You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
6661 C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
6662 a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
6663 if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
6664 current revision number from the more remote backend.
6665
6666 If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
6667 another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
6668 any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
6669 pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
6670
6671 After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
6672 changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
6673 local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
6674 buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
6675
6676 *** Changes for CVS
6677
6678 There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
6679 default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
6680 remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
6681 by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
6682 regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
6683 that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
6684 queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
6685
6686 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
6687 repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
6688 revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
6689 any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
6690 backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
6691 number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
6692 (vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
6693 of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
6694 the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
6695 automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
6696 since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
6697 name.)
6698
6699 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
6700 repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
6701 If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
6702 commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
6703 current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
6704 entire directory tree.
6705
6706 The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
6707 "cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
6708 is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
6709 "watched" by other developers.)
6710
6711 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
6712 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
6713 an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
6714 starting at the given directory.
6715
6716 *** Lisp Changes in VC
6717
6718 VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
6719 add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
6720 library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
6721 then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
6722 a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
6723 provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
6724 of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
6725 you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
6726 `SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
6727
6728 ** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
6729 SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
6730 terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
6731 See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
6732
6733 ** New modes and packages
6734
6735 *** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
6736 automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
6737 the default is not applicable.
6738
6739 *** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
6740 rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
6741 shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
6742
6743 Features are:
6744
6745 - Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
6746 drawn, like this: | \ /
6747 --+-- X
6748 | / \
6749
6750 - Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
6751 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
6752 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
6753 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
6754 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
6755 you are drawing.
6756
6757 - Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
6758 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
6759
6760 - Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
6761 flood-filling.
6762
6763 - Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
6764 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
6765 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
6766 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
6767
6768 - Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
6769 also do without the mouse.
6770
6771 - Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
6772 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
6773 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
6774 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
6775 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
6776
6777 - Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
6778
6779 lines straight-lines
6780 rectangles squares
6781 poly-lines straight poly-lines
6782 ellipses circles
6783 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
6784 spray-can setting size for spraying
6785 vaporize line vaporize lines
6786 erase characters erase rectangles
6787
6788 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
6789 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
6790 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
6791 drawing.
6792
6793 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
6794 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
6795 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
6796 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
6797
6798 - Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
6799 can be turned off).
6800
6801 *** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
6802 implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
6803 It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
6804 functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
6805 history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
6806 will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
6807 the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
6808 rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
6809 all within the scope of your Emacs process.
6810
6811 *** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
6812 intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
6813 typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
6814 on certain projects.
6815
6816 *** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
6817 of interactively entered regexps. For example,
6818
6819 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
6820
6821 will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
6822 face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
6823 typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
6824 Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
6825 appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
6826 current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
6827 corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
6828 to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
6829
6830 *** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
6831 Emacs is idle.
6832
6833 *** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
6834 fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
6835
6836 *** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
6837 parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
6838
6839 *** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
6840 package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
6841 be more robust while offering the same functionality.
6842 `comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
6843 comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
6844
6845 *** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
6846 facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
6847 separate Texinfo file.
6848
6849 *** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
6850 by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
6851 provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
6852 `log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
6853 enter check-in log messages.
6854
6855 *** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
6856 without invoking external programs.
6857
6858 The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
6859 and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
6860 `manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
6861 is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
6862 Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
6863
6864 The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
6865 page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
6866
6867 *** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
6868 authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
6869
6870 The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
6871 the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
6872 the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
6873 Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
6874 even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
6875 single step.
6876
6877 On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
6878 matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
6879 probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
6880 contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
6881
6882 *** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
6883 unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
6884 actually modifying content of a buffer.
6885
6886 *** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
6887 PostScript.
6888
6889 Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
6890
6891 The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
6892
6893 ; comment (until end of line)
6894 A non-terminal
6895 "C" terminal
6896 ?C? special
6897 $A default non-terminal
6898 $"C" default terminal
6899 $?C? default special
6900 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
6901 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
6902 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
6903 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
6904 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
6905 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
6906 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
6907 C+ one or more occurrences of C
6908 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
6909 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
6910 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
6911 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
6912 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
6913 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
6914 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
6915
6916 Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
6917
6918 *** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
6919 align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
6920 determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
6921 example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
6922 equal signs of assignments.
6923
6924 *** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
6925 paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
6926
6927 *** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
6928 list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
6929 buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
6930
6931 *** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
6932
6933 *** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
6934 replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
6935 is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
6936 and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
6937 not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
6938 which answers different needs.
6939
6940 *** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
6941 suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
6942 expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
6943 course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
6944 reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
6945 to be enabled.
6946
6947 *** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
6948 containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
6949
6950 *** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
6951
6952 *** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
6953 current line in the current buffer. It also provides
6954 `global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
6955
6956 *** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
6957
6958 Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
6959 `global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
6960 disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
6961 `comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
6962 displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
6963 and background colors.
6964
6965 *** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
6966 Pascal) language.
6967
6968 *** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
6969 the text at point.
6970
6971 *** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
6972
6973 *** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
6974
6975 *** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
6976 whitespace in a file.
6977
6978 *** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
6979 files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
6980 (very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
6981 interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
6982 often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
6983 uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
6984 codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
6985
6986 *** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
6987
6988 Here is an example of columns:
6989
6990 horse apple bus
6991 dog pineapple car EXTRA
6992 porcupine strawberry airplane
6993
6994 Doing the following settings:
6995
6996 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
6997 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
6998 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
6999 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
7000
7001
7002 Selecting the lines above and typing:
7003
7004 M-x delimit-columns-region
7005
7006 It results:
7007
7008 [ horse , apple , bus , ]
7009 [ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
7010 [ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
7011
7012 delim-col has the following options:
7013
7014 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
7015 before all columns.
7016
7017 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
7018 between each column.
7019
7020 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
7021 after all columns.
7022
7023 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
7024 each column.
7025
7026 delim-col has the following commands:
7027
7028 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
7029 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
7030
7031 *** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
7032 operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
7033 menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
7034 recent file list can be displayed:
7035
7036 - organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
7037 - sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
7038 - showing paths relative to the current default-directory
7039
7040 The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
7041 dynamically change the menu appearance.
7042
7043 *** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
7044 text.
7045
7046 *** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
7047 of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
7048 specific to Message mode.
7049
7050 *** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
7051 viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
7052 with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
7053
7054 *** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
7055 interface to access directory servers using different directory
7056 protocols. It has a separate manual.
7057
7058 *** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
7059 for Autoconf, selected automatically.
7060
7061 *** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
7062
7063 *** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
7064 minibuffer with completion.
7065
7066 *** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
7067 with the diary features.
7068
7069 *** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
7070 numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
7071
7072 *** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
7073 Fill mode.
7074
7075 *** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
7076 facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
7077 difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
7078 they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
7079
7080 *** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
7081 It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
7082 `.g'.
7083
7084 ** Changes in sort.el
7085
7086 The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
7087 as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
7088 new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
7089 numeric base.
7090
7091 ** Changes to Ange-ftp
7092
7093 *** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
7094 names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
7095 sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
7096
7097 *** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
7098 ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
7099
7100 *** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
7101 output ^M at the end of lines.
7102
7103 ** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
7104 mode `iswitchb-mode'.
7105
7106 ** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
7107 If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
7108 `(msb-mode 1)'.
7109
7110 ** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
7111 group.
7112
7113 ** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
7114 behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
7115 are recognized:
7116
7117 `untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
7118 `hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
7119 `all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
7120 nil -- just delete one character.
7121
7122 Default value is `untabify'.
7123
7124 [This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
7125
7126 ** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
7127 symbol, not double-quoted.
7128
7129 ** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
7130 version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
7131 profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
7132 moved to lisp/obsolete.
7133
7134 ** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
7135 To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
7136 `auto-compression-mode' command.
7137
7138 ** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
7139 `browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
7140 `browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
7141
7142 ** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
7143 `browse-url-new-window-flag'.
7144
7145 ** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
7146 operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
7147
7148 ** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
7149 is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
7150
7151 ** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
7152 support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
7153 use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
7154 buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
7155 M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
7156 new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
7157
7158 ** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
7159 a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
7160
7161 ** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
7162
7163 The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
7164 file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
7165
7166 ** Shell script mode changes.
7167
7168 Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
7169 derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
7170 sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
7171
7172 ** Etags changes.
7173
7174 *** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
7175
7176 *** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
7177 possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
7178 {lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
7179 This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
7180 a regular expression. The manual contains details.
7181
7182 *** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
7183 declarations when given the --declarations option.
7184
7185 *** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
7186 "operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
7187
7188 *** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
7189 automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
7190 `template' keywords.
7191
7192 *** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
7193 C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
7194
7195 *** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
7196 types.
7197
7198 *** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
7199
7200 *** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
7201
7202 *** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
7203 are now tagged.
7204
7205 *** In makefiles, tags the targets.
7206
7207 *** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
7208 variables are tagged.
7209
7210 *** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
7211
7212 *** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
7213 for PSWrap.
7214
7215 ** Changes in etags.el
7216
7217 *** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
7218 tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
7219 is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
7220
7221 *** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
7222 the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
7223
7224 If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
7225 FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
7226 TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
7227 obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
7228
7229 TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
7230
7231 FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
7232 List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
7233
7234 A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
7235
7236 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
7237 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
7238 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
7239
7240 *** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
7241 of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
7242
7243 *** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
7244 names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
7245
7246 *** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
7247 If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
7248 /tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
7249 "dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
7250 point will go to the beginning of the file.
7251
7252 *** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
7253 auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
7254 (with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
7255
7256 *** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
7257 in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
7258 found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
7259
7260 ** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
7261 remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
7262 appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
7263
7264 ** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
7265
7266 ** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
7267
7268 ** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
7269 containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
7270 expression from that list, are not checked.
7271
7272 ** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
7273 When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
7274 and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
7275 the buffer, just like for the local files.
7276
7277 ** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
7278
7279 ** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
7280 displays local abbrevs, only.
7281
7282 ** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
7283 paragraphs filled as you modify them.
7284
7285 ** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
7286 may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
7287 is measured in pixels.
7288
7289 ** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
7290 to be visited as images.
7291
7292 ** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
7293 were added to compile.el.
7294
7295 ** Withdrawn packages
7296
7297 *** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
7298 functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
7299
7300 *** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
7301
7302 *** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
7303
7304 \f
7305 * Incompatible Lisp changes
7306
7307 There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
7308 may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
7309 See the sections below for details.
7310
7311 ** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
7312 `(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
7313 Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
7314 to remove the properties of the copy.
7315
7316 ** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
7317 which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
7318 may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
7319 these properties are active.
7320
7321 ** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
7322 ranges may affect some code.
7323
7324 ** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
7325 buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
7326 make a difference to some code.
7327
7328 ** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
7329 operates on the minibuffer.
7330
7331 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
7332 cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
7333 different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
7334 (previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
7335 Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
7336 character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
7337 multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
7338 encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
7339 reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
7340 sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
7341 a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
7342 the buffer as multibyte characters.
7343
7344 Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
7345 MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
7346 appropriate for reading truly binary files.
7347
7348 ** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
7349 `after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
7350 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
7351
7352 ** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
7353 long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
7354 such as `mapconcat'.
7355
7356 ** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
7357 string.
7358
7359 ** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
7360 extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
7361 dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
7362 one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
7363 charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
7364 the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
7365 encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
7366 probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
7367
7368 ** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
7369 Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
7370 aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
7371 not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
7372 on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
7373 behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
7374 turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
7375 remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
7376 advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
7377 will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
7378
7379 \f
7380 * Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
7381 (Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
7382
7383 ** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
7384
7385 ** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
7386 allows the animated display of strings.
7387
7388 ** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
7389 interactive form of a function.
7390
7391 ** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
7392 between custom options. Example:
7393
7394 (defcustom default-input-method nil
7395 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
7396 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
7397 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
7398 :group 'mule
7399 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
7400 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
7401
7402 This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
7403 current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
7404 first in a custom-set-variables statement.
7405
7406 ** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
7407 function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
7408 args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
7409 (signal or normal termination).
7410
7411 ** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
7412 from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
7413
7414 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
7415 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
7416
7417 ** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
7418 alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
7419
7420 ** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
7421
7422 ** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
7423 deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
7424 being deleted.
7425
7426 ** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
7427
7428 ** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
7429 If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
7430 skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
7431 with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
7432 C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
7433 charset.
7434
7435 ** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
7436 the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
7437 message.
7438
7439 ** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
7440 expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
7441
7442 ** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
7443 with the more general `:mask' property.
7444
7445 ** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
7446
7447 ** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
7448 backslash.
7449
7450 ** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
7451 is running in batch mode. For example,
7452
7453 (message "%s" (read t))
7454
7455 will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
7456 to standard output.
7457
7458 ** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
7459 `kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
7460
7461 ** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
7462 will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
7463 frame or window.
7464
7465 ** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
7466 were added
7467
7468 - Function: remove ELT SEQ
7469
7470 Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
7471 a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
7472
7473 - Function: remq ELT LIST
7474
7475 Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
7476 comparison is done with `eq'.
7477
7478 ** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
7479
7480 ** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
7481 has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
7482 `key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
7483
7484 ** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
7485 without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
7486 convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
7487
7488 ** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
7489 or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
7490
7491 ** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
7492 function was declared obsolete.
7493
7494 ** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
7495 retained as an alias).
7496
7497 ** Easy-menu's :filter now takes the unconverted form of the menu and
7498 the result is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
7499
7500 ** The new function `window-list' has been defined
7501
7502 - Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
7503
7504 Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
7505 omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
7506 the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
7507 even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
7508 minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
7509 means never include the minibuffer window.
7510
7511 ** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
7512
7513 - Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
7514
7515 Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
7516
7517 This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
7518 calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
7519 argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
7520 value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
7521 returned.
7522
7523 Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
7524 if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
7525 it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
7526 minibuffer even if it is active.
7527
7528 Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
7529 counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
7530 too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
7531 and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
7532 `walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
7533 entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
7534
7535 ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
7536 ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
7537 ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
7538 ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
7539 ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
7540 If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
7541 Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
7542
7543 ** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
7544 event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
7545 argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
7546
7547 ** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
7548 call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
7549 message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
7550 Default value is nil.
7551
7552 ** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
7553 meaning no limit.
7554
7555 ** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
7556 the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
7557 numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
7558
7559 ** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
7560 coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
7561 DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
7562
7563 ** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
7564 list of a primitive.
7565
7566 ** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
7567
7568 ** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
7569 buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
7570 This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
7571 than replacing the local map.
7572
7573 ** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
7574 `after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
7575 removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
7576 instead.
7577
7578 ** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
7579
7580 ** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
7581 as promised long ago.
7582
7583 ** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
7584
7585 ** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
7586 for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
7587 patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
7588
7589 \f
7590 * Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
7591
7592 ** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
7593 regular expressions.
7594
7595 - Function: rx-to-string SEXP
7596
7597 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7598
7599 - Macro: rx SEXP
7600
7601 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7602
7603 The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
7604 notation.
7605
7606 STRING
7607 matches string STRING literally.
7608
7609 CHAR
7610 matches character CHAR literally.
7611
7612 `not-newline'
7613 matches any character except a newline.
7614 .
7615 `anything'
7616 matches any character
7617
7618 `(any SET)'
7619 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
7620 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
7621
7622 '(in SET)'
7623 like `any'.
7624
7625 `(not (any SET))'
7626 matches any character not in SET
7627
7628 `line-start'
7629 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
7630 in the text being matched
7631
7632 `line-end'
7633 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
7634
7635 `string-start'
7636 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
7637 string being matched against.
7638
7639 `string-end'
7640 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
7641 string being matched against.
7642
7643 `buffer-start'
7644 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
7645 buffer being matched against.
7646
7647 `buffer-end'
7648 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
7649 buffer being matched against.
7650
7651 `point'
7652 matches the empty string, but only at point.
7653
7654 `word-start'
7655 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
7656 word.
7657
7658 `word-end'
7659 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
7660
7661 `word-boundary'
7662 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
7663 word.
7664
7665 `(not word-boundary)'
7666 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
7667 word.
7668
7669 `digit'
7670 matches 0 through 9.
7671
7672 `control'
7673 matches ASCII control characters.
7674
7675 `hex-digit'
7676 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
7677
7678 `blank'
7679 matches space and tab only.
7680
7681 `graphic'
7682 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
7683 space, and DEL.
7684
7685 `printing'
7686 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
7687 and DEL.
7688
7689 `alphanumeric'
7690 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7691 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7692
7693 `letter'
7694 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7695 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7696
7697 `ascii'
7698 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
7699
7700 `nonascii'
7701 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
7702
7703 `lower'
7704 matches anything lower-case.
7705
7706 `upper'
7707 matches anything upper-case.
7708
7709 `punctuation'
7710 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7711 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
7712
7713 `space'
7714 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
7715
7716 `word'
7717 matches anything that has word syntax.
7718
7719 `(syntax SYNTAX)'
7720 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
7721 of the following symbols.
7722
7723 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
7724 `punctuation' (\\s.)
7725 `word' (\\sw)
7726 `symbol' (\\s_)
7727 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
7728 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
7729 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
7730 `string-quote' (\\s\")
7731 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
7732 `escape' (\\s\\)
7733 `character-quote' (\\s/)
7734 `comment-start' (\\s<)
7735 `comment-end' (\\s>)
7736
7737 `(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
7738 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
7739
7740 `(category CATEGORY)'
7741 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
7742 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
7743
7744 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
7745 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
7746 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
7747 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
7748 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
7749 `symbol' (\\c5)
7750 `digit' (\\c6)
7751 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
7752 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
7753 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
7754 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
7755 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
7756 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
7757 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
7758 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
7759 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
7760 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
7761 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
7762 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
7763 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
7764 `ascii' (\\ca)
7765 `arabic' (\\cb)
7766 `chinese' (\\cc)
7767 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
7768 `greek' (\\cg)
7769 `korean' (\\ch)
7770 `indian' (\\ci)
7771 `japanese' (\\cj)
7772 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
7773 `latin' (\\cl)
7774 `lao' (\\co)
7775 `tibetan' (\\cq)
7776 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
7777 `thai' (\\ct)
7778 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
7779 `hebrew' (\\cw)
7780 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
7781 `can-break' (\\c|)
7782
7783 `(not (category CATEGORY))'
7784 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
7785
7786 `(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7787 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
7788
7789 `(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7790 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
7791 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
7792
7793 `(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7794 another name for `submatch'.
7795
7796 `(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7797 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
7798 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
7799 regular expression.
7800
7801 `(minimal-match SEXP)'
7802 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
7803 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
7804 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
7805 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
7806
7807 `(maximal-match SEXP)'
7808 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
7809
7810 `(zero-or-more SEXP)'
7811 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7812
7813 `(0+ SEXP)'
7814 like `zero-or-more'.
7815
7816 `(* SEXP)'
7817 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7818
7819 `(*? SEXP)'
7820 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7821
7822 `(one-or-more SEXP)'
7823 matches one or more occurrences of A.
7824
7825 `(1+ SEXP)'
7826 like `one-or-more'.
7827
7828 `(+ SEXP)'
7829 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7830
7831 `(+? SEXP)'
7832 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7833
7834 `(zero-or-one SEXP)'
7835 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
7836
7837 `(optional SEXP)'
7838 like `zero-or-one'.
7839
7840 `(? SEXP)'
7841 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7842
7843 `(?? SEXP)'
7844 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7845
7846 `(repeat N SEXP)'
7847 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7848
7849 `(repeat N M SEXP)'
7850 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7851
7852 `(eval FORM)'
7853 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
7854 `regexp-quote' it.
7855
7856 `(regexp REGEXP)'
7857 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
7858
7859 *** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
7860
7861 *** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
7862 buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
7863 the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
7864 restriction to be restored incorrectly.
7865
7866 *** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
7867 `eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
7868 when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
7869 multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
7870
7871 *** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
7872 `string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
7873 if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
7874
7875 *** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
7876 changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
7877 [\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
7878 regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
7879 the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
7880 extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
7881 bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
7882 eight-bit-graphic.
7883
7884 ** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
7885
7886 A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
7887 a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
7888 character set as previously.
7889
7890 *** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
7891 They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
7892 modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
7893
7894 CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
7895 characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
7896 range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
7897 case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
7898
7899 FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
7900 name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
7901
7902 *** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
7903 registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
7904 "fontset-default".
7905
7906 *** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
7907 argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
7908
7909 ** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
7910 composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
7911 buffers and strings.
7912
7913 *** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
7914 character' which is an independent character with a unique character
7915 code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
7916 have been deleted: composite-char-component,
7917 composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
7918 composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
7919 The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
7920 also been deleted.
7921
7922 *** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
7923 specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
7924 `reference-point-alist' for more detail.
7925
7926 *** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
7927 MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
7928 composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
7929 may differ between buffer and string text.
7930
7931 *** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
7932 COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
7933
7934 *** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
7935 directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
7936 Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
7937 `composition' from STRING.
7938
7939 *** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
7940 a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
7941
7942 *** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
7943 obsolete.
7944
7945 ** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
7946 the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
7947
7948 ** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
7949 `mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
7950 introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
7951 U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
7952
7953 Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
7954 characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
7955 etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
7956 different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
7957 which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
7958 encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
7959
7960 ** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
7961 It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
7962 details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
7963
7964 ** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
7965 `japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
7966 standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
7967
7968 ** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
7969 have been introduced.
7970
7971 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
7972 have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
7973 0xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
7974 eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
7975 emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
7976 buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
7977 eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
7978 must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
7979 their multibyte equivalent.
7980
7981 ** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
7982 that offset in the file before writing.
7983
7984 ** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
7985 compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
7986
7987 ** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
7988 `*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
7989 from which the command was issued.
7990
7991 ** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
7992 `query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
7993 `replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
7994 additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
7995 operate on.
7996
7997 ** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
7998 to `window-buffer-height'.
7999
8000 - Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
8001
8002 Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
8003 The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
8004 lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
8005
8006 Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
8007 respectively.
8008
8009 If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
8010 COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
8011
8012 The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
8013 obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
8014 on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
8015
8016 Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
8017 buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
8018 possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
8019 is currently displayed in some window.
8020
8021 ** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
8022 argument function's results.
8023
8024 ** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
8025 signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
8026 `base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
8027 20, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
8028 sequence).
8029
8030 ** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
8031 header in the list of headers passed to it.
8032
8033 ** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
8034 ignores differences in case and text representation.
8035
8036 ** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
8037 cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
8038 as follows:
8039
8040 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
8041 nil don't display a cursor
8042 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
8043 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
8044 others display a box cursor.
8045
8046 ** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
8047 an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
8048 defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
8049 set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
8050
8051 ** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
8052 specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
8053 the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
8054 text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
8055
8056 Example:
8057
8058 (string-to-syntax "()")
8059 => (4 . 41)
8060
8061 ** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
8062 other than 10.
8063
8064 *** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
8065 INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
8066
8067 #b1111
8068 => 15
8069 #b-1111
8070 => -15
8071
8072 *** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
8073
8074 #o666
8075 => 438
8076
8077 *** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
8078
8079 #xbeef
8080 => 48815
8081
8082 *** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
8083
8084 #2R-111
8085 => -7
8086 #25rah
8087 => 267
8088
8089 ** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
8090 the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
8091 and isn't a string.
8092
8093 ** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
8094 a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
8095 value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
8096 not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
8097
8098 ** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
8099
8100 ** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
8101 for a regexp in a string.
8102
8103 ** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
8104 `mouse-position-function'.
8105
8106 ** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
8107 that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
8108
8109 ** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
8110 Keywords are now always considered constants.
8111
8112 ** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
8113 returns it.
8114
8115 ** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
8116 returned by function `recent-keys'.
8117
8118 ** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
8119 can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
8120 Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
8121 etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
8122 mode.
8123
8124 ** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
8125 and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
8126
8127 ** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
8128 has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
8129 function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
8130 returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
8131 been performed."
8132
8133 When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
8134 and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
8135 hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
8136 then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
8137
8138 ** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
8139 In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
8140 and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
8141
8142 ** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
8143 with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
8144 specified table.
8145
8146 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
8147
8148 Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
8149 TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
8150 saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
8151 what BODY returns.
8152
8153 ** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
8154 Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
8155 Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
8156 corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
8157 Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
8158
8159 ** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
8160 removed since it wasn't used by anything.
8161
8162 ** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
8163 instead of being optional.
8164
8165 ** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
8166 modify read-only text.
8167
8168 ** New functions and variables for locales.
8169
8170 The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
8171 decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
8172 time functions like strftime. The new variables
8173 `system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
8174 locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
8175
8176 The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
8177 environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
8178 the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
8179 environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
8180 not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
8181 `locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
8182 `locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
8183
8184 ** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
8185 To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
8186 modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
8187 start sequences.
8188
8189 ** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
8190 because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
8191
8192 ** New function `propertize'
8193
8194 The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
8195 strings with text properties.
8196
8197 - Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
8198
8199 Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
8200 by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
8201 PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
8202 specified value of that property. Example:
8203
8204 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
8205
8206 ** push and pop macros.
8207
8208 Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
8209 are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
8210 as the place that holds the list to be changed.
8211
8212 (push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
8213 (pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
8214 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
8215
8216 ** New dolist and dotimes macros.
8217
8218 Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
8219 are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
8220
8221 (dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
8222 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
8223 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
8224 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8225
8226 (dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
8227 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
8228 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
8229 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8230
8231 ** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
8232 [:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
8233 class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
8234 or a sign.
8235
8236 [:digit:] matches 0 through 9
8237 [:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
8238 [:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
8239 [:blank:] matches space and tab only
8240 [:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
8241 space, and DEL.
8242 [:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
8243 and DEL.
8244 [:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
8245 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8246 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8247 [:alpha:] matches letters.
8248 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8249 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8250 [:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
8251 [:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
8252 [:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
8253 [:punct:] matches punctuation.
8254 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8255 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
8256 [:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
8257 [:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
8258 [:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
8259
8260 ** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
8261
8262 The following functions are defined for hash tables:
8263
8264 - Function: make-hash-table ARGS
8265
8266 The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
8267 are optional. The following arguments are defined:
8268
8269 :test TEST
8270
8271 TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
8272 Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
8273 it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
8274
8275 :size SIZE
8276
8277 SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
8278 many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
8279
8280 :rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
8281
8282 REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
8283 full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
8284 size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
8285 1.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
8286 old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
8287
8288 :rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
8289
8290 THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
8291 hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
8292 (size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
8293
8294 :weakness WEAK
8295
8296 WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
8297 `key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
8298 `key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
8299 collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
8300 outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
8301
8302 - Function: makehash &optional TEST
8303
8304 Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
8305
8306 - Function: hash-table-p TABLE
8307
8308 Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
8309
8310 - Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
8311
8312 Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
8313 values are shared.
8314
8315 - Function: hash-table-count TABLE
8316
8317 Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
8318
8319 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8320
8321 Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
8322
8323 - Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
8324
8325 Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
8326
8327 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8328
8329 Returns the size of TABLE.
8330
8331 - Function: hash-table-test TABLE
8332
8333 Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
8334
8335 - Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
8336
8337 Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
8338
8339 - Function: clrhash TABLE
8340
8341 Clear TABLE.
8342
8343 - Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
8344
8345 Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
8346 not found.
8347
8348 - Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
8349
8350 Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
8351 another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
8352
8353 - Function: remhash KEY TABLE
8354
8355 Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
8356
8357 - Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
8358
8359 Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
8360 arguments KEY and VALUE.
8361
8362 - Function: sxhash OBJ
8363
8364 Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
8365
8366 - Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
8367
8368 Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
8369 a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
8370 comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
8371 and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
8372 of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
8373
8374 TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
8375
8376 HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
8377 code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
8378 integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
8379
8380 Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
8381 be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
8382
8383 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
8384 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
8385
8386 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
8387 (sxhash (upcase a)))
8388
8389 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
8390 'case-fold-string-hash))
8391
8392 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
8393
8394 ** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
8395
8396 It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
8397 circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
8398 a cons cell which is its own cdr.
8399
8400 ** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
8401
8402 If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
8403 #N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
8404
8405 ** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
8406 t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
8407 specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
8408 is too short to reach that column.
8409
8410 ** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
8411 now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
8412 after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
8413 two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
8414
8415 If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
8416 perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
8417 and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
8418
8419 ** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
8420 to specify which buffer to return the size of.
8421
8422 ** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
8423 calendar-move-hook after moving point.
8424
8425 ** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
8426 directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
8427 small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
8428 small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
8429 temporary-file-directory instead.
8430
8431 ** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
8432 the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
8433 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
8434 hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
8435
8436 ** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
8437 elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
8438
8439 ** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
8440
8441 make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
8442 creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
8443 ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
8444
8445 ** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
8446
8447 The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
8448 on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
8449 is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
8450 never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
8451 ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
8452 overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
8453
8454 If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
8455 that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
8456 to get an error if the file exists at that time.
8457 The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
8458
8459 ** Function `format' now handles text properties.
8460
8461 Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
8462 If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
8463 ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
8464 result string.
8465
8466 Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
8467 string where arguments appear in the result string.
8468
8469 Example:
8470
8471 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
8472 (s2 "world"))
8473 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
8474 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
8475 (format s1 s2))
8476
8477 results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
8478
8479 ** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
8480
8481 Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
8482 The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
8483 argument in it.
8484
8485 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
8486 (arg "world"))
8487 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
8488 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
8489 (message msg arg))
8490
8491 ** Sound support
8492
8493 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
8494 (Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
8495
8496 Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
8497 (*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
8498 to enable sound support.
8499
8500 Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
8501 list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
8502 when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
8503 functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
8504 sound to play, before playing the sound.
8505
8506 The following sound properties are supported:
8507
8508 - `:file FILE'
8509
8510 FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
8511 searched relative to `data-directory'.
8512
8513 - `:data DATA'
8514
8515 DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
8516 may be present, but not both.
8517
8518 - `:volume VOLUME'
8519
8520 VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
8521 0..1. This property is optional.
8522
8523 - `:device DEVICE'
8524
8525 DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
8526 sound. The default device is system-dependent.
8527
8528 Other properties are ignored.
8529
8530 An alternative interface is called as
8531 (play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
8532
8533 ** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
8534
8535 ** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
8536 a keyword symbol.
8537
8538 ** Changes to garbage collection
8539
8540 *** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
8541 of live and free strings.
8542
8543 *** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
8544 strings that have been consed so far.
8545
8546 \f
8547 * Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
8548 Lisp Manual
8549
8550 ** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
8551 mini-windows.
8552
8553 ** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
8554 argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
8555 returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
8556
8557 ** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
8558
8559 ** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
8560
8561 ** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
8562 image.
8563
8564 - Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
8565
8566 Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
8567
8568 SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
8569 measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
8570 character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
8571 font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
8572 FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
8573
8574 ** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
8575 has a mask bitmap.
8576
8577 - Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
8578
8579 Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
8580 FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
8581 or omitted means use the selected frame.
8582
8583 ** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
8584 satisfying one of a list of specifications.
8585
8586 ** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
8587 optional.
8588
8589 ** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
8590 below).
8591
8592 \f
8593 * New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
8594
8595 ** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
8596 to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
8597
8598 Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
8599 text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
8600 is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
8601 your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
8602 laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
8603 just display it black instead.
8604
8605 This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
8606 a line like
8607
8608 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
8609
8610 in your `.emacs'.
8611
8612 ** New face implementation.
8613
8614 Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
8615 font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
8616
8617 *** New faces.
8618
8619 Each face can specify the following display attributes:
8620
8621 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
8622
8623 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
8624 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
8625
8626 3. Font height in 1/10pt
8627
8628 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
8629
8630 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
8631
8632 6. Foreground color.
8633
8634 7. Background color.
8635
8636 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
8637
8638 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
8639
8640 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
8641
8642 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
8643
8644 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
8645 color.
8646
8647 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
8648 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
8649
8650 Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
8651 same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
8652 frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
8653 faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
8654 with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
8655 attributes mentioned above.
8656
8657 There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
8658 definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
8659 created frames.
8660
8661 A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
8662 have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
8663 `fully-specified'.
8664
8665 *** Face merging.
8666
8667 The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
8668 combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
8669 aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
8670 properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
8671 that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
8672 results in a fully-specified face.
8673
8674 *** Face realization.
8675
8676 After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
8677 merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
8678 realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
8679 available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
8680 face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
8681 cache of the frame on which it was realized.
8682
8683 Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
8684 character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
8685 for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
8686 charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
8687
8688 Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
8689 specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
8690 being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
8691 the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
8692 statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
8693
8694 In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
8695 `char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
8696 0x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
8697 the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
8698 initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
8699 Emacs.
8700
8701 Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
8702 `enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
8703 registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
8704 with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
8705
8706 **** Clearing face caches.
8707
8708 The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
8709 on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
8710 unused fonts.
8711
8712 *** Font selection.
8713
8714 Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
8715 given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
8716 for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
8717
8718 If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
8719 pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
8720 family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
8721 property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
8722 an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
8723
8724 Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
8725 against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
8726 match for the given face attributes in this font list.
8727
8728 Font selection can be influenced by the user.
8729
8730 The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
8731 attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
8732 face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
8733 names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
8734 that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
8735 width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
8736 to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
8737
8738 Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8739 alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
8740 doesn't exist.
8741
8742 Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8743 all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
8744 registry.
8745
8746 Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
8747 slightly different.
8748
8749 Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
8750
8751
8752 **** Scalable fonts
8753
8754 Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
8755 since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
8756 servers.
8757
8758 To enable scalable font use, set the variable
8759 `scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
8760 scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
8761 Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
8762 scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
8763 that list. Example:
8764
8765 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
8766
8767 allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
8768
8769 *** Functions and variables related to font selection.
8770
8771 - Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
8772
8773 Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
8774 is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
8775 string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
8776
8777 If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
8778 the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
8779 FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
8780 POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
8781 SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
8782 These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
8783 if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
8784 REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
8785 the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
8786 of the face font sort order.
8787
8788 - Function: x-font-family-list
8789
8790 Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
8791 omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
8792 (FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
8793 non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
8794
8795 - Variable: font-list-limit
8796
8797 Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
8798 won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
8799 matching font. The default is currently 100.
8800
8801 *** Setting face attributes.
8802
8803 For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
8804 with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
8805 implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
8806 `face-attribute'.
8807
8808 Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
8809 symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
8810
8811 The following attributes are recognized:
8812
8813 `:family'
8814
8815 VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
8816 or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
8817 and `?' are allowed.
8818
8819 `:width'
8820
8821 VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
8822 It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
8823 `condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
8824 `extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
8825
8826 `:height'
8827
8828 VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
8829 in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
8830 scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
8831 height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
8832
8833 `:weight'
8834
8835 VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
8836 symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
8837 `semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
8838
8839 `:slant'
8840
8841 VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
8842 symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
8843 `reverse-oblique'.
8844
8845 `:foreground', `:background'
8846
8847 VALUE must be a color name, a string.
8848
8849 `:underline'
8850
8851 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
8852 VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
8853 a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
8854 don't underline.
8855
8856 `:overline'
8857
8858 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
8859 VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
8860 string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
8861 overline.
8862
8863 `:strike-through'
8864
8865 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
8866 striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
8867 face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
8868 is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
8869
8870 `:box'
8871
8872 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
8873 around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
8874 VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
8875 of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
8876 and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
8877 VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
8878 :color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
8879 the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
8880 specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
8881 defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
8882 the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
8883 color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
8884 should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
8885 like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
8886 that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
8887 the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
8888 box.
8889
8890 `:inverse-video'
8891
8892 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
8893 inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
8894
8895 `:stipple'
8896
8897 If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
8898 The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
8899 searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
8900 HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
8901 is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
8902 explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
8903
8904 For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
8905 and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
8906
8907 `:font'
8908
8909 Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
8910 XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
8911 is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
8912 versions of Emacs.
8913
8914 For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
8915 be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
8916 must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
8917
8918 Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
8919 `defface'.
8920
8921 `:inherit'
8922
8923 VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
8924 of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
8925 like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
8926
8927 *** Face attributes and X resources
8928
8929 The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
8930 from X resources:
8931
8932 Face attribute X resource class
8933 -----------------------------------------------------------------------
8934 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
8935 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
8936 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
8937 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
8938 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
8939 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
8940 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
8941 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
8942 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
8943 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
8944 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
8945 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
8946 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
8947 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
8948 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
8949 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
8950 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
8951 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
8952 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
8953
8954 *** Text property `face'.
8955
8956 The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
8957 specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
8958 specification can be
8959
8960 1. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
8961
8962 2. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
8963 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
8964 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
8965 for face attribute names.
8966
8967 3. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
8968 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
8969 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
8970
8971 ** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
8972
8973 The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
8974 on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
8975 the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
8976 default. You can get defined colors with a call to
8977 `defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
8978 used to clear the mapping table.
8979
8980 ** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
8981
8982 The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
8983 and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
8984 type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
8985 color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
8986 display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
8987 old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
8988 `x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
8989 compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
8990 should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
8991 modify their color-related behavior.
8992
8993 The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
8994 any frame type.
8995
8996 ** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
8997
8998 The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
8999 `display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
9000 `display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
9001 `display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
9002 `display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
9003 `display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
9004 display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
9005 the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
9006 platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
9007
9008 The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
9009 display can display image files.
9010
9011 ** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
9012
9013 This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
9014 To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
9015 the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
9016 `Inviolable' option.
9017
9018 The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
9019 end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
9020 Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
9021
9022 ** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
9023
9024 There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
9025 buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
9026 property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
9027
9028 Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
9029 forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
9030 to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
9031 not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
9032 commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
9033 boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
9034 `inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
9035 functions.
9036
9037 Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
9038 a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
9039 editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
9040
9041 The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
9042
9043 - Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
9044
9045 Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
9046
9047 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9048 If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
9049 constrained position if that is different.
9050
9051 If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
9052 positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
9053 ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
9054 constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
9055 as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9056 is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
9057 fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
9058 the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
9059 also considered to be `on the boundary'.
9060
9061 If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
9062 NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
9063 unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
9064 C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
9065 only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
9066
9067 If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
9068 a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
9069
9070 Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
9071
9072 - Function: delete-field &optional POS
9073
9074 Delete the field surrounding POS.
9075 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9076 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9077
9078 - Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9079
9080 Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
9081 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9082 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9083 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
9084 field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
9085
9086 - Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9087
9088 Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
9089 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9090 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9091 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
9092 then the end of the *following* field is returned.
9093
9094 - Function: field-string &optional POS
9095
9096 Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
9097 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9098 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9099
9100 - Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
9101
9102 Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
9103 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9104 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9105
9106 ** Image support.
9107
9108 Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
9109 strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
9110 (AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
9111 replaces the display of the characters having that property.
9112
9113 If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
9114 `(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
9115 AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
9116 window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
9117 area.
9118
9119 IMAGE is an image specification.
9120
9121 *** Image specifications
9122
9123 Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
9124 is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
9125 specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
9126 symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
9127 described below are ignored.
9128
9129 The following is a list of properties all image types share.
9130
9131 `:ascent ASCENT'
9132
9133 ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
9134 If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
9135 to use for its ascent.
9136
9137 If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
9138 image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
9139
9140 If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
9141 centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
9142 of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
9143 overlays that apply to the image.
9144
9145 `:margin MARGIN'
9146
9147 MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
9148 as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
9149 horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
9150
9151 `:relief RELIEF'
9152
9153 RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
9154 around an image.
9155
9156 `:conversion ALGO'
9157
9158 Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
9159
9160 ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
9161 edge-detection algorithm to the image.
9162
9163 ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
9164 apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
9165 nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
9166 position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
9167 around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
9168 neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
9169 transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
9170 x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
9171 below.
9172
9173 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
9174 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
9175 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
9176
9177 The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
9178 resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
9179 multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
9180 of the factors' absolute values.
9181
9182 Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
9183
9184 (1 0 0
9185 0 0 0
9186 9 9 -1)
9187
9188 Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
9189
9190 ( 2 -1 0
9191 -1 0 1
9192 0 1 -2)
9193
9194 ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
9195 ``disabled''.
9196
9197 `:mask MASK'
9198
9199 If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
9200 the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
9201 image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
9202 background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
9203 image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
9204 the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
9205 GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
9206 image.
9207
9208 If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
9209 in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
9210 `:mask nil'.
9211
9212 `:file FILE'
9213
9214 Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
9215 search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
9216 building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
9217 may be present in the image specification.
9218
9219 `:data DATA'
9220
9221 Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
9222 supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
9223 present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
9224 support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
9225
9226 *** Supported image types
9227
9228 **** XBM, image type `xbm'.
9229
9230 XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
9231 properties supported are:
9232
9233 `:foreground FG'
9234
9235 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9236 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9237
9238 `:background BG'
9239
9240 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9241 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9242
9243 XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
9244 case, the image specification must contain the following properties
9245 instead of a `:file' property.
9246
9247 `:width WIDTH'
9248
9249 WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
9250
9251 `:height HEIGHT'
9252
9253 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
9254
9255 `:data DATA'
9256
9257 DATA must be either
9258
9259 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
9260 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
9261
9262 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
9263
9264 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
9265 bitmap.
9266
9267 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
9268 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
9269 in the file.
9270
9271 **** XPM, image type `xpm'
9272
9273 XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
9274 `xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
9275 found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
9276 `--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
9277
9278 Additional image properties supported are:
9279
9280 `:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
9281
9282 SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
9283 name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
9284 name.
9285
9286 XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
9287 add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
9288
9289 The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
9290 to display compressed images.
9291
9292 **** PBM, image type `pbm'
9293
9294 PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
9295 mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
9296 mono images are:
9297
9298 `:foreground FG'
9299
9300 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9301 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9302
9303 `:background FG'
9304
9305 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9306 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9307
9308 **** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
9309
9310 Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
9311 package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9312 properties defined.
9313
9314 **** TIFF, image type `tiff'
9315
9316 Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
9317 package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9318 properties defined.
9319
9320 **** GIF, image type `gif'
9321
9322 Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
9323 `libungif-4.1.0', or later.
9324
9325 Additional image properties supported are:
9326
9327 `:index INDEX'
9328
9329 INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
9330 multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays
9331 as a hollow box.
9332
9333 This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
9334 For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
9335 at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
9336 every 0.1 seconds.
9337
9338 (defun show-anim (file max)
9339 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
9340 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
9341
9342 (defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
9343 (when (= idx max)
9344 (setq idx 0))
9345 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
9346 (save-excursion
9347 (set-buffer buffer)
9348 (goto-char (point-min))
9349 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
9350 (insert-image img "x"))
9351 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
9352
9353 **** PNG, image type `png'
9354
9355 Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
9356 package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9357 properties defined.
9358
9359 **** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
9360
9361 Additional image properties supported are:
9362
9363 `:pt-width WIDTH'
9364
9365 WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
9366 integer. This is a required property.
9367
9368 `:pt-height HEIGHT'
9369
9370 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
9371 must be a integer. This is an required property.
9372
9373 `:bounding-box BOX'
9374
9375 BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
9376 the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
9377 files. This is an required property.
9378
9379 Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
9380 lisp/gs.el.
9381
9382 *** Lisp interface.
9383
9384 The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
9385 which are supported in the current configuration.
9386
9387 Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
9388 they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
9389 The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
9390 manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
9391 images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
9392
9393 *** Simplified image API, image.el
9394
9395 The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
9396 creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
9397 can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
9398 define an image based on available image types. The functions
9399 `put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
9400 buffer.
9401
9402 ** Display margins.
9403
9404 Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
9405 and images.
9406
9407 To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
9408 `left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
9409 `set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
9410 obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
9411 `right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
9412 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
9413 of the display margins.
9414
9415 You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
9416 containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
9417 one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
9418 string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
9419 in this file).
9420
9421 ** Help display
9422
9423 Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
9424 moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
9425 `help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
9426 that have a `help-echo' property.
9427
9428 If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
9429 is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
9430 the window in which the help was found.
9431
9432 If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
9433 `help-echo' text property was found.
9434
9435 If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
9436 POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
9437
9438 If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
9439 the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
9440 mouse.
9441
9442 If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
9443 string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
9444
9445 For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
9446 determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
9447 property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
9448 For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
9449 used as help string.
9450
9451 The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
9452 the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
9453 causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
9454
9455 ** Vertical fractional scrolling.
9456
9457 The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
9458 This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
9459
9460 The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
9461 scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
9462 The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
9463 scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
9464 used.
9465
9466 (global-set-key [A-down]
9467 #'(lambda ()
9468 (interactive)
9469 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9470 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
9471 (global-set-key [A-up]
9472 #'(lambda ()
9473 (interactive)
9474 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9475 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
9476
9477 ** New hook `fontification-functions'.
9478
9479 Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
9480 when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
9481 variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
9482 is called with one argument, POS.
9483
9484 At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
9485 characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
9486 as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
9487 property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
9488 `fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
9489
9490 ** Tool bar support.
9491
9492 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
9493 parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
9494 controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
9495 suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
9496 `auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
9497 automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
9498
9499 *** Tool bar item definitions
9500
9501 Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
9502 `tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
9503 where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
9504
9505 CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
9506 evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
9507 the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
9508 property (see below).
9509
9510 BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
9511 binding are currently ignored.
9512
9513 The following properties are recognized:
9514
9515 `:enable FORM'.
9516
9517 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
9518 or disabled.
9519
9520 `:visible FORM'
9521
9522 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
9523
9524 `:filter FUNCTION'
9525
9526 FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
9527 FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
9528 used instead of BINDING to display this item.
9529
9530 `:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
9531
9532 TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
9533 and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
9534
9535 `:image IMAGES'
9536
9537 IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
9538 image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
9539 meaning of each of the four elements:
9540
9541 Index Use when item is
9542 ----------------------------------------
9543 0 enabled and selected
9544 1 enabled and deselected
9545 2 disabled and selected
9546 3 disabled and deselected
9547
9548 If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
9549 algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
9550
9551 `:help HELP-STRING'.
9552
9553 Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
9554 is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
9555
9556 The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
9557 toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
9558 to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
9559 menu bar.
9560
9561 The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
9562 dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
9563 buffer-locally to override the global map.
9564
9565 *** Tool-bar-related variables.
9566
9567 If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
9568 resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
9569 than 1/4 of the frame's size.
9570
9571 If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
9572 raised when the mouse moves over them.
9573
9574 You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
9575 `tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
9576 pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
9577 vertical margins . Default is 1.
9578
9579 You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
9580 `tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
9581
9582 *** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
9583
9584 You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
9585 a tool bar item. If
9586
9587 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
9588 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
9589 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
9590
9591 is the original tool bar item definition, then
9592
9593 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
9594
9595 makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
9596 item.
9597
9598 ** Mode line changes.
9599
9600 *** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
9601
9602 The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
9603 that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
9604 a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
9605
9606 1. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
9607 a `local-map' text property.
9608
9609 2. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
9610 that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
9611
9612 3. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
9613 is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
9614 `local-map' property.
9615
9616 The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
9617 properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
9618 example.
9619
9620 *** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
9621 evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
9622
9623 *** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
9624 variable mode-line-format to nil.
9625
9626 *** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
9627
9628 This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
9629 `header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
9630 completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
9631 `default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
9632 line.
9633
9634 The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
9635 `header-line'.
9636
9637 The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
9638 position in the header-line.
9639
9640 ** Text property `display'
9641
9642 The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
9643 replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
9644 also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
9645 the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
9646 below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
9647
9648 *** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
9649
9650 To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
9651 text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
9652
9653 If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
9654 marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
9655 the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
9656 is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
9657 simpler form STRING as property value.
9658
9659 *** Variable width and height spaces
9660
9661 To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
9662 specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
9663 `(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
9664 area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
9665 marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
9666 displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
9667 simpler form STRETCH as property value.
9668
9669 The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
9670 PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
9671 properties described below.
9672
9673 The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
9674 characters having the `display' property.
9675
9676 - :width WIDTH
9677
9678 Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
9679 character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
9680
9681 - :relative-width FACTOR
9682
9683 Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
9684 first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
9685 same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
9686 width of that character by FACTOR.
9687
9688 - :align-to HPOS
9689
9690 Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
9691 value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
9692
9693 Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
9694
9695 - :height HEIGHT
9696
9697 Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
9698 normal line height.
9699
9700 - :relative-height FACTOR
9701
9702 The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
9703 of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
9704
9705 - :ascent ASCENT
9706
9707 Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
9708 used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
9709 baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
9710 equal to 100.
9711
9712 You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
9713
9714 *** Images
9715
9716 A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
9717 . IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
9718 in the display, the characters having this display specification in
9719 their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
9720 the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
9721 `(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
9722 area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
9723 the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
9724 as display specification.
9725
9726 *** Other display properties
9727
9728 - (space-width FACTOR)
9729
9730 Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
9731 should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
9732 integer or float.
9733
9734 - (height HEIGHT)
9735
9736 Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
9737
9738 If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
9739 means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
9740 the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
9741 ``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
9742 a font is available counts as a step.
9743
9744 If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
9745 as tall as the frame's default font.
9746
9747 If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
9748 height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
9749
9750 Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
9751 `height' bound to the current specified font height.
9752
9753 - (raise FACTOR)
9754
9755 FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
9756 font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
9757 raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
9758 amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
9759 `height' subproperty.
9760
9761 *** Conditional display properties
9762
9763 All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
9764 has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
9765 only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
9766 evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
9767 conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
9768 bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
9769 the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
9770 different when object is a string.
9771
9772 The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
9773 `(when t . SPEC)'.
9774
9775 ** New menu separator types.
9776
9777 Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
9778 item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
9779 treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
9780 to specify other menu separator types.
9781
9782 - `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
9783
9784 No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
9785 separator occurs.
9786
9787 - `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
9788
9789 A single line in the menu's foreground color.
9790
9791 - `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
9792
9793 A double line in the menu's foreground color.
9794
9795 - `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
9796
9797 A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
9798
9799 - `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
9800
9801 A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
9802
9803 - `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
9804
9805 A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
9806 displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
9807
9808 - `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
9809
9810 A single line with 3D raised appearance.
9811
9812 - `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
9813
9814 A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
9815
9816 - `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
9817
9818 A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
9819
9820 - `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
9821
9822 Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
9823
9824 - `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
9825
9826 Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
9827
9828 - `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
9829
9830 Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
9831
9832 - `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
9833
9834 Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
9835
9836 Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
9837 the corresponding single-line separators.
9838
9839 ** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
9840
9841 The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
9842 `scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
9843 Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
9844 that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
9845 default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
9846 default background is the background color of the frame, and the
9847 default foreground is black.
9848
9849 The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
9850 (class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
9851 `ScrollBarBackground').
9852
9853 Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
9854 settings for scroll bar colors.
9855
9856 ** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
9857 display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
9858
9859 ** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
9860 starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
9861 on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
9862 line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
9863 the original window start.
9864
9865 ** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
9866 `hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
9867 now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
9868
9869 ** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
9870
9871 A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
9872 `window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
9873 windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
9874 other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
9875
9876 The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
9877 fixed-width and fixed-height.
9878
9879 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
9880
9881 A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
9882 fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
9883 window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
9884 change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
9885 temporarily to nil, for example
9886
9887 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
9888 (enlarge-window 10))
9889
9890 Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
9891 or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
9892
9893 ** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
9894 terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
9895 to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
9896 overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
9897 horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
9898 support a vertical-bar cursor).
9899
9900
9901 \f
9902 * Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
9903
9904 ** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
9905 input.
9906
9907 ** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
9908
9909 ** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
9910
9911 ** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
9912 only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
9913 exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
9914 (e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
9915 (e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
9916
9917 ** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
9918 been added.
9919
9920 \f
9921 * Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
9922
9923 ** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
9924
9925
9926 \f
9927 * Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
9928
9929 ** Not new, but not mentioned before:
9930 M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
9931 \f
9932 * Changes in Emacs 20.4
9933
9934 ** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
9935
9936 You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
9937 Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
9938 `.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
9939
9940 If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
9941 is the one that is used.
9942
9943 ** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
9944 the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
9945 Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
9946 separate from the command's regular output.
9947 Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
9948 says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
9949 In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
9950 the buffer name.
9951
9952 When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
9953 output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
9954 it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
9955 cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
9956
9957 ** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
9958 the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
9959 is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
9960 created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
9961
9962 ** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
9963 example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
9964 match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
9965 quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
9966
9967 ** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
9968 now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
9969 if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
9970 they never ignore case.
9971
9972 ** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
9973 under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
9974 applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
9975 of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
9976 just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
9977 convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
9978 part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
9979
9980 If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
9981 the same format that was used in the file before.
9982
9983 You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
9984 `inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
9985
9986 ** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
9987 renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
9988 This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
9989
9990 ** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
9991 The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
9992 buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
9993 your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
9994 is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
9995 end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
9996 Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
9997
9998 The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
9999 eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
10000 control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
10001 format. You can now customize these variables.
10002
10003 ** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
10004 filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
10005 filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
10006 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
10007
10008 ** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
10009 in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
10010 windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
10011
10012 ** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
10013 dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
10014 doesn't have any effect.
10015
10016 ** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
10017 not one per buffer.
10018
10019 ** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
10020 use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
10021 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
10022
10023 ** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
10024 To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
10025 `auto-show-mode' command.
10026
10027 ** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
10028 avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
10029 versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
10030 choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
10031 occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
10032
10033 ** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
10034 cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
10035
10036 ** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
10037 character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
10038 feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
10039
10040 ** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
10041 the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
10042 interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
10043 and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
10044
10045 ** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
10046
10047 The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
10048 that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
10049 one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
10050 codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
10051 set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
10052
10053 Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
10054 from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
10055
10056 IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
10057 equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
10058 a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
10059 `?' on other systems.
10060
10061 IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
10062 feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
10063 Unix.
10064
10065 Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
10066 current codepage when it starts.
10067
10068 ** Mail changes
10069
10070 *** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
10071 `mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
10072 appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
10073 non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
10074 MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
10075 headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
10076 latin-1:
10077
10078 MIME-version: 1.0
10079 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
10080 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
10081
10082 *** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
10083 default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
10084 default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
10085 sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
10086 buffer-file-coding-system.
10087
10088 You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
10089 sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
10090 mail.
10091
10092 *** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
10093 if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
10094 Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
10095 list of possible coding systems.
10096
10097 ** CC Mode changes
10098
10099 *** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
10100 modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
10101 longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
10102 docstring for details.
10103
10104 *** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
10105 symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
10106 found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
10107 prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
10108 lineup functions use this feature currently.
10109
10110 *** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
10111 "finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
10112
10113 *** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
10114 "catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
10115
10116 *** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
10117 from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
10118 symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
10119 c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
10120 anonymous classes.
10121
10122 *** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
10123 syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
10124
10125 *** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
10126 inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
10127 support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
10128 function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
10129
10130 *** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
10131 (i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
10132 brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
10133 c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
10134 (brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
10135
10136 *** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
10137
10138 *** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
10139
10140 *** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
10141 for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
10142
10143 *** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
10144
10145 *** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
10146 associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
10147 This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
10148 circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
10149 class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
10150
10151 ** Gnus changes.
10152
10153 *** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
10154 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
10155 Gnus manual for the full story.
10156
10157 *** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
10158 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
10159 group, which is created automatically.
10160
10161 *** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
10162 values.
10163
10164 *** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
10165
10166 *** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
10167 outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
10168
10169 *** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
10170 `C-u C-c C-c'.
10171
10172 *** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
10173
10174 *** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
10175 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
10176
10177 *** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
10178
10179 *** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
10180 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
10181
10182 *** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
10183 `a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
10184
10185 *** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
10186 control over simplification.
10187
10188 *** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
10189
10190 *** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
10191 limit.
10192
10193 *** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
10194
10195 *** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
10196
10197 *** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
10198 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
10199 rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
10200
10201 *** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
10202 `a' forces normal posting method.
10203
10204 *** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
10205 -- `W d'.
10206
10207 *** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
10208 to a non-nil value.
10209
10210 *** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
10211 where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
10212
10213 *** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
10214 has been added.
10215
10216 *** A history of where mails have been split is available.
10217
10218 *** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
10219
10220 *** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
10221 `gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
10222
10223 *** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
10224 `message-cite-original-without-signature'.
10225
10226 *** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
10227
10228 *** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
10229 been added.
10230
10231 *** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
10232 `gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
10233
10234 *** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
10235 updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
10236
10237 *** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
10238
10239 *** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
10240
10241 *** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
10242
10243 ** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
10244
10245 *** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
10246 options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
10247 nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
10248
10249 *** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
10250 TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
10251 of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
10252 TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
10253 can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
10254
10255 *** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
10256 All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
10257 but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
10258 the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
10259
10260 *** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
10261 the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
10262 buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
10263 mismatch.
10264
10265 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
10266
10267 *** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
10268 file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
10269
10270 *** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
10271 lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
10272 characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
10273 removed from the label.
10274
10275 *** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
10276 a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
10277
10278 *** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
10279 customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
10280
10281 *** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
10282 `reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
10283 expressions.
10284
10285 *** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
10286
10287 ** New/deleted modes and packages
10288
10289 *** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
10290 SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
10291
10292 *** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
10293 editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
10294 SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
10295
10296 *** M-x highlight-changes-mode provides a minor mode displaying buffer
10297 changes with a special face.
10298
10299 *** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
10300 this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
10301 Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
10302 \f
10303 * MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
10304
10305 ** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
10306 This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
10307 conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
10308 and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
10309 check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
10310
10311 The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
10312 Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
10313 distribution when the config.bat script is run.
10314
10315 ** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
10316 MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
10317 controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
10318 directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
10319 Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
10320 on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
10321 string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
10322 program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
10323 printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
10324
10325 ** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
10326 output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
10327 available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
10328 input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
10329 temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
10330 program.
10331
10332 An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
10333 and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
10334 programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
10335 automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
10336 as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
10337 ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
10338
10339 ** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
10340 a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
10341 MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
10342 was not documented clearly before.
10343
10344 ** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
10345 This includes Tetris and Snake.
10346 \f
10347 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
10348
10349 ** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
10350 return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
10351 They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
10352 meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
10353
10354 ** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
10355 WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
10356 and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
10357
10358 ** Changes in the file-attributes function.
10359
10360 *** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
10361 It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
10362
10363 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
10364 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
10365 integers.
10366
10367 ** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
10368 files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
10369 arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
10370 file names and attributes are returned.
10371
10372 ** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
10373 sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
10374 accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
10375 It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
10376 returns the result.
10377
10378 ** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
10379 to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
10380
10381 ** New functions for base64 conversion:
10382
10383 The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
10384 into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
10385 performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
10386 optionally.
10387
10388 Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
10389 job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
10390
10391 **
10392 The new function process-running-child-p
10393 will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
10394 terminal to its own child process.
10395
10396 ** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
10397 when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
10398 to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
10399 itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
10400
10401 ** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
10402 be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
10403
10404 ** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
10405 :included is an alias for :visible.
10406
10407 easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
10408 easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
10409 to move or copy menu entries.
10410
10411 ** Multibyte editing changes
10412
10413 *** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
10414 an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
10415 make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
10416 work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
10417 char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
10418 (setq char (sref str idx)
10419 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
10420 The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
10421
10422 If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
10423 (say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
10424 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
10425
10426 *** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
10427 region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
10428 deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
10429
10430 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
10431
10432 This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
10433 across the boundary.
10434
10435 *** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
10436 `unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
10437 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
10438 contains 8-bit characters.
10439 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
10440 contains invalid characters.
10441
10442 *** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
10443 text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
10444 preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
10445 text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
10446 way.
10447
10448 *** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
10449 If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
10450 end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
10451 prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
10452
10453 *** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
10454 compose Thai characters in a string.
10455
10456 ** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
10457 argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
10458 for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
10459 menus should always use the third argument.
10460
10461 ** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
10462 read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
10463 arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
10464 input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
10465
10466 ** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
10467 of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
10468 programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
10469 inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
10470
10471 ** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
10472 the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
10473 returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
10474 echo area contents.
10475
10476 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
10477
10478 ** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
10479 NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
10480 requested feature cannot be loaded.
10481
10482 ** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
10483 foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
10484 means to clear out that attribute.
10485
10486 ** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
10487 gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
10488
10489 ** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
10490 read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
10491 unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
10492 end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
10493
10494 ** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
10495 the gap of the current buffer.
10496
10497 ** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
10498 to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
10499 current buffer.
10500
10501 ** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
10502 facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
10503 These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
10504 it back in after any modifications have been made.
10505 \f
10506 * Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
10507
10508 ** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
10509 the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
10510 /usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
10511 directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
10512 subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
10513
10514 Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
10515 names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
10516 Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
10517 which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
10518 these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
10519
10520 Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
10521 starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
10522 time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
10523
10524 This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
10525 Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
10526 to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
10527 subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
10528 `.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
10529 results.
10530
10531 ** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
10532 GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
10533 that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
10534 fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
10535 \f
10536 * Changes in Emacs 20.3
10537
10538 ** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
10539 including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
10540 it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
10541 perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
10542
10543 ** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
10544 specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
10545 region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
10546 further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
10547 command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
10548 within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
10549 are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
10550 region.
10551
10552 In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
10553 selective undo.
10554
10555 ** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
10556 unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
10557 buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
10558 effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
10559 Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
10560
10561 The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
10562 though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
10563 -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
10564 load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
10565
10566 ** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
10567 no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
10568 enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
10569 something that most users not do.
10570
10571 ** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
10572 operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
10573 The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
10574 applications.
10575
10576 C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
10577 pasting operations.
10578
10579 ** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
10580 setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
10581 like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
10582 printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
10583 `ps-printer-name'.
10584
10585 ** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
10586 minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
10587 any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
10588 except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
10589 incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
10590 hits a new word.
10591
10592 Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
10593 Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
10594 to be confused by TeX commands.
10595
10596 You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
10597 correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
10598 clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
10599 of various alternative replacements and actions.
10600
10601 Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
10602 the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
10603 corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
10604 alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
10605 flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
10606
10607 Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
10608 flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
10609
10610 ** Changes in input method usage.
10611
10612 Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
10613 the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
10614 respectively.
10615
10616 You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
10617
10618 If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
10619 of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
10620
10621 The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
10622 that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
10623
10624 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
10625
10626 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
10627
10628 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
10629 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
10630
10631 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
10632 given in the following case:
10633 o When you are using a complex input method.
10634 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
10635
10636 If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
10637 input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
10638 and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
10639 setting it to t is helpful.
10640
10641 The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
10642
10643 In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
10644 keys:
10645 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
10646 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
10647 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
10648 These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
10649 environment.
10650
10651 ** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
10652 names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
10653 minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
10654 get
10655
10656 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
10657
10658 which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
10659
10660 Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
10661 Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
10662
10663 ** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
10664 at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
10665 its owner and group.
10666
10667 ** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
10668 Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
10669
10670 ** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
10671 contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
10672
10673 ** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
10674 which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
10675 in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
10676 by the left edge of the rectangle.
10677
10678 ** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
10679 increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
10680 C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
10681 for writing keyboard macros.
10682
10683 ** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
10684 files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
10685 frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
10686 the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
10687 additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
10688 info.
10689
10690 ** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
10691
10692 ** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
10693 query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
10694 contents only.
10695
10696 ** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
10697 confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
10698 the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
10699 says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
10700
10701 ** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
10702 non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
10703 literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
10704
10705 ** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
10706 now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
10707 Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
10708 inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
10709
10710 ** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
10711 failure if the command produces no output.
10712
10713 ** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
10714 manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
10715 the mouse.
10716
10717 ** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
10718 mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
10719 function and variable names.
10720
10721 ** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
10722 reading specific files. This has higher priority than
10723 file-coding-system-alist.
10724
10725 ** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
10726 t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
10727 converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
10728 the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
10729 according to the current fontset.
10730
10731 ** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
10732
10733 The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
10734 that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
10735 nonascii-insert-offset.
10736
10737 For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
10738 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
10739 nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
10740 characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
10741
10742 ** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
10743 an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
10744
10745 ** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
10746 letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
10747
10748 ** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
10749 are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
10750 command keys.
10751
10752 ** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
10753 user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
10754
10755 Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
10756 user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
10757 all variables that have documentation.
10758
10759 ** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
10760 shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
10761 that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
10762 minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
10763 it should show; the default is 20.
10764
10765 Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
10766 the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
10767 of your input.
10768
10769 ** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
10770 all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
10771 recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
10772 argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
10773 the customizable options which were changed since that version.
10774 Newly added options are included as well.
10775
10776 If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
10777 then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
10778 for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
10779
10780 This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
10781 Customize menu.
10782
10783 ** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
10784 the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
10785
10786 ** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
10787 buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
10788 invoked.
10789
10790 ** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
10791 that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
10792 The default is 1.
10793
10794 ** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
10795 syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
10796 new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
10797 (C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
10798 sensibly.
10799
10800 ** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
10801
10802 ** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
10803 value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
10804 two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
10805
10806 ** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
10807 reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
10808 for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
10809 every night.
10810
10811 ** Desktop changes
10812
10813 *** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
10814 the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
10815
10816 *** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
10817 and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
10818
10819 ** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
10820 read and post multi-lingual articles.
10821
10822 ** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
10823 doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
10824 be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
10825 outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
10826 the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
10827 made invisible again.
10828
10829 ** Mail reading and sending changes
10830
10831 *** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
10832 the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
10833 changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
10834 toggle.
10835
10836 *** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
10837 now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
10838 summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
10839 the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
10840 rmail-default-body-file.
10841
10842 *** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
10843 longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
10844 handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
10845
10846 *** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
10847 it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
10848 is evaluated to insert the signature.
10849
10850 *** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
10851 outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
10852 handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
10853 putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
10854 transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
10855 especially interested in trying feedmail.
10856
10857 feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
10858 feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
10859 provided by feedmail are:
10860
10861 **** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
10862 stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
10863 there is also a queue for draft messages
10864
10865 **** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
10866 be prompted for confirmation
10867
10868 **** does smart filling of address headers
10869
10870 **** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
10871 the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
10872 can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
10873
10874 **** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
10875 the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
10876 /usr/lib/sendmail, and Emacs Lisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
10877 function for something else (10-20 lines of Lisp code).
10878
10879 ** Dired changes
10880
10881 *** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
10882 files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
10883
10884 *** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
10885 run Dired on the directory name at point.
10886
10887 *** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
10888 files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
10889 for a specified regexp.
10890
10891 ** VC Changes
10892
10893 *** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
10894 conveniently.
10895
10896 *** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
10897 faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
10898 Dired.
10899
10900 VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
10901 directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
10902 listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
10903 currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
10904
10905 You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
10906 then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
10907 vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
10908 control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
10909 on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
10910
10911 All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
10912 is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
10913 `v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
10914 the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
10915 `vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
10916
10917 The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
10918 toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
10919 VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
10920 `* l', to mark all files currently locked.
10921
10922 Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
10923 ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
10924 command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
10925
10926 *** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
10927 file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
10928 session to resolve them.
10929
10930 Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
10931 resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
10932 contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
10933 uses as well).
10934
10935 *** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
10936 command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
10937 you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
10938 either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
10939 branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
10940 If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
10941 using ediff.
10942
10943 ** Changes in Font Lock
10944
10945 *** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
10946 are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
10947 use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
10948 unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
10949 compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
10950
10951 ** Frame name display changes
10952
10953 *** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
10954 frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
10955 raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
10956 when many frames are invisible or iconified.
10957
10958 *** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
10959 frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
10960 menu.
10961
10962 ** Comint (subshell) changes
10963
10964 *** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
10965 subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
10966 with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
10967
10968 *** There are new commands in Comint mode.
10969
10970 C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
10971 that is, the line after the last line you got.
10972 You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
10973
10974 C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
10975 send the current line together with the following line, when you send
10976 the following line.
10977
10978 C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
10979 which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
10980 previously sent input.
10981
10982 C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
10983 it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
10984 as the search string.
10985
10986 *** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
10987 automatically in compilation-mode windows.
10988
10989 ** C mode changes
10990
10991 *** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
10992 and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
10993 assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
10994 definition.
10995
10996 *** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
10997 (i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
10998 Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
10999 style is still the default however.
11000
11001 *** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
11002
11003 *** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
11004 are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
11005 them. They do not have key bindings by default.
11006
11007 *** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
11008 and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
11009
11010 *** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
11011 namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
11012
11013 *** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
11014 makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
11015
11016 *** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
11017 c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
11018
11019 *** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
11020 should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
11021 package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
11022 variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
11023
11024 ** Changes to hippie-expand.
11025
11026 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
11027 non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
11028 which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
11029
11030 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
11031 non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
11032 expanding dynamically.
11033
11034 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
11035 non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
11036
11037 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
11038 non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
11039 this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
11040 expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
11041
11042 *** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
11043
11044 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
11045
11046 *** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
11047 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
11048 automatic key generation. This replaces variable
11049 bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
11050 against the first word in the title.
11051
11052 *** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
11053 capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
11054 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
11055 lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
11056 lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
11057 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
11058
11059 *** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
11060 generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
11061 replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
11062 bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
11063
11064 ** Changes in vcursor.el.
11065
11066 *** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
11067 and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
11068 variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
11069 entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
11070 `vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
11071 in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
11072
11073 *** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
11074 Editing group once the package is loaded.
11075
11076 *** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
11077 generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
11078 vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
11079
11080 *** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
11081 vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
11082
11083 ** Ispell changes.
11084
11085 *** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
11086 buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
11087 are identified by syntax tables in effect.
11088
11089 *** Generic region skipping implemented.
11090 A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
11091 and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
11092 defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
11093 include:
11094
11095 o URLs are automatically skipped
11096 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
11097
11098 *** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
11099
11100 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
11101
11102 RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
11103 large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
11104 re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
11105 section `Optimizations' in the manual.
11106
11107 *** New recursive parser.
11108
11109 The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
11110 entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
11111 recursive parser scans the individual files.
11112
11113 *** Parsing only part of a document.
11114
11115 Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
11116 partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
11117 the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
11118
11119 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
11120
11121 *** Storing parsing information in a file.
11122
11123 This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
11124
11125 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
11126
11127 *** Using multiple selection buffers
11128
11129 If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
11130 for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
11131
11132 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
11133
11134 *** References to external documents.
11135
11136 The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
11137 documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
11138 documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
11139 macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
11140 RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
11141 the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
11142 The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
11143
11144 *** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
11145
11146 The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
11147 and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
11148
11149 Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
11150 the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
11151
11152 *** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
11153
11154 The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
11155 buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
11156
11157 *** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
11158
11159 The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
11160 contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
11161 `reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
11162 have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
11163 enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
11164 at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
11165 more.
11166
11167 *** Support for the varioref package
11168
11169 The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
11170
11171 *** New hooks
11172
11173 Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
11174 and citations are created. These hooks are
11175 `reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
11176 `reftex-format-cite-function'.
11177
11178 *** Citations outside LaTeX
11179
11180 The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
11181 a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
11182
11183 *** Short context is no longer fontified.
11184
11185 The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
11186 fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
11187 fontified, use
11188
11189 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
11190
11191 ** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
11192 With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
11193 the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
11194 directories that contain the same file name.
11195
11196 Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
11197 Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
11198 file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
11199 Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
11200 have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
11201 names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
11202 directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
11203 directory.
11204
11205 ** New modes and packages
11206
11207 *** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
11208 It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
11209 it, but some do not.
11210
11211 *** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
11212 code.
11213
11214 *** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
11215 current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
11216 around in a buffer.
11217
11218 Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
11219
11220 *** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
11221 uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
11222 be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
11223 established system of notation similar to Chess.
11224
11225 *** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
11226 documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
11227 guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
11228
11229 *** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
11230 available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
11231 system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc); others are implementations of
11232 simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
11233 functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
11234 the like.
11235
11236 *** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
11237 identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
11238
11239 *** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
11240 within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
11241 used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
11242 the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
11243
11244 *** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
11245
11246 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
11247 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
11248 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
11249 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
11250 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc)
11251 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
11252 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
11253 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
11254 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
11255 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
11256 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
11257
11258 Platform-specific modes:
11259
11260 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
11261 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
11262 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
11263 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
11264 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
11265 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
11266 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
11267 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
11268 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
11269 \f
11270 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11271
11272 ** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
11273 use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
11274 That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
11275 Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
11276
11277 Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
11278 you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
11279 consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
11280
11281 ** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
11282 and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
11283 specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
11284 searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
11285
11286 ** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
11287 multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
11288 character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
11289 environment.
11290
11291 ** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
11292 take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
11293 string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
11294 current input method for reading this one event.
11295
11296 ** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
11297 now control whether to output certain characters as
11298 backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
11299 non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
11300 characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
11301 in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
11302 \f
11303 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11304
11305 ** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
11306 of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
11307
11308 ** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
11309 in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
11310 always increases point by 1.
11311
11312 The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
11313 considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
11314
11315 See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
11316
11317 ** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
11318 Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
11319 default value changed. For example,
11320
11321 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
11322 :type 'integer
11323 :group 'foo
11324 :version "20.3")
11325
11326 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
11327 :version "20.3")
11328
11329 If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
11330 default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
11331 is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
11332 `:version' in the top level group.
11333
11334 This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
11335
11336 ** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
11337 starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
11338
11339 However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
11340 symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
11341 support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
11342 to themselves.
11343
11344 If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
11345 this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
11346 values whatever.
11347
11348 ** There is a new debugger command, R.
11349 It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
11350 in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
11351
11352 ** Frame-local variables.
11353
11354 You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
11355 the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
11356 local bindings for that variable.
11357
11358 These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
11359 frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
11360 modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
11361 parameter name.
11362
11363 Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
11364 Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
11365 active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
11366 that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
11367
11368 It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
11369 clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
11370 very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
11371 through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
11372
11373 ** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
11374 "symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
11375 evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
11376 makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
11377 See the documentation in sregex.el.
11378
11379 ** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
11380 is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
11381 parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
11382 The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
11383
11384 ** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
11385 If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
11386
11387 ** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
11388 known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
11389 define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
11390
11391 ** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
11392 when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
11393 it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
11394 history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
11395
11396 The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
11397 return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
11398 empty input.
11399
11400 ** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
11401 for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
11402 `iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
11403 Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
11404 `read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
11405
11406 ** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
11407 echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
11408 a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
11409 default password to use if the user enters nothing.
11410
11411 ** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
11412 specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
11413 function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
11414 place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
11415 non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
11416
11417 ** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
11418 If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
11419 up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
11420 end of the window, even if this requires computation.
11421
11422 ** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
11423 which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
11424 If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
11425
11426 ** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
11427 holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
11428 was directed to display this buffer.
11429
11430 ** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
11431 with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
11432 describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
11433 other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
11434 set-window-configuration.
11435
11436 ** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
11437 window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
11438 positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
11439 windows and the choice of buffers to display.
11440
11441 ** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
11442 override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
11443 look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
11444
11445 If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
11446 non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
11447 map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
11448
11449 minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
11450 and it is meant to be set by major modes.
11451
11452 ** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
11453 except that it discards all text properties from the result.
11454
11455 ** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
11456 USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
11457 floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
11458
11459 ** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
11460 to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
11461 in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
11462 it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
11463
11464 ** Menu changes
11465
11466 *** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
11467 keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
11468 better supported.
11469
11470 The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
11471 a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
11472 you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
11473 can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
11474 then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
11475
11476 *** A new format for menu items is supported.
11477
11478 In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
11479 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
11480 defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
11481 starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
11482
11483 The format is:
11484 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
11485 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
11486 where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
11487 string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
11488 The supported properties include
11489
11490 :enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11491 item is enabled.
11492 :visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11493 item should appear in the menu.
11494 :filter FILTER-FN
11495 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
11496 which will be REAL-BINDING.
11497 It should return a binding to use instead.
11498 :keys DESCRIPTION
11499 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
11500 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
11501 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
11502 :key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
11503 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
11504 keyboard binding.
11505 :key-sequence nil
11506 This means that the command normally has no
11507 keyboard equivalent.
11508 :help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
11509 :button (TYPE . SELECTED)
11510 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
11511 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
11512 value says whether this button is currently selected.
11513
11514 Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
11515 Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
11516
11517 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
11518
11519 ** New event types
11520
11521 *** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
11522 mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
11523 corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
11524 which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
11525
11526 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
11527
11528 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11529 same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
11530 indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
11531 negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
11532 the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
11533 forward, away from the user.
11534
11535 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11536
11537 *** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
11538 files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
11539 and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
11540 filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
11541 loaded into Emacs. The format is:
11542
11543 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
11544
11545 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11546 same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
11547 that were dragged and dropped.
11548
11549 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11550
11551 ** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
11552
11553 *** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
11554 any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
11555 to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
11556
11557 *** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
11558 can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
11559 that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
11560
11561 *** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
11562 in Emacs 19 and before.
11563
11564 The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
11565 The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
11566
11567 *** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
11568 buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
11569 unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
11570 representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
11571
11572 This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
11573 as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
11574 viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
11575 one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
11576 will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
11577
11578 This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
11579 representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
11580 (including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
11581 consistent with the new representation.
11582
11583 *** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
11584 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
11585 about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
11586 however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11587
11588 The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
11589 nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
11590 using the table nonascii-translation-table.
11591
11592 *** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
11593 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
11594 representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11595
11596 The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
11597 loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
11598 is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
11599
11600 *** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11601 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
11602
11603 *** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11604 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
11605
11606 *** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
11607 portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
11608 so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
11609 You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
11610
11611 *** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
11612 it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
11613
11614 *** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
11615 convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
11616 buffer or string being searched.
11617
11618 One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
11619 [...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
11620 searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
11621 searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
11622 obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
11623 you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
11624 expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
11625
11626 *** Structure of coding system changed.
11627
11628 All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
11629 by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
11630 which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
11631 as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
11632 vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
11633 your own alias name of a coding system by the function
11634 define-coding-system-alias.
11635
11636 The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
11637 the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
11638 access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
11639 pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
11640 character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
11641 safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
11642 'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
11643 `iso-8859-1'.
11644
11645 Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
11646 The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
11647 coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
11648 (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
11649
11650 Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
11651 also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
11652 are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
11653 the other character sets and read it back correctly.
11654
11655 *** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
11656 proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
11657 This function requires a user interaction.
11658
11659 *** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
11660 find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
11661 select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
11662 systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
11663 a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
11664 select-safe-coding-system.
11665
11666 *** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
11667 decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
11668 last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
11669 was done.
11670
11671 *** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
11672 used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
11673 coding systems used by some specific language environment.
11674
11675 *** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
11676 return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
11677 characters are found, they now return a list of single element
11678 `undecided' or its subsidiaries.
11679
11680 *** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
11681 coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
11682 coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
11683 converted.
11684
11685 *** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
11686 coding system for communicating with other X clients.
11687
11688 *** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
11689 character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
11690 character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
11691 each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
11692 either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
11693 range of characters.
11694
11695 *** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
11696 Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
11697
11698 *** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
11699 in the current buffer at position POS.
11700
11701 *** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
11702 input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
11703 function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
11704 character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
11705 event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
11706 binding input-method-function to nil.
11707
11708 The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
11709 method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
11710 input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
11711 the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
11712 not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
11713
11714 The input method function is not called when reading the second and
11715 subsequent events of a key sequence.
11716
11717 *** You can customize any language environment by using
11718 set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
11719
11720 The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
11721 customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
11722 instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
11723 environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
11724 exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
11725 \f
11726 * Changes in Emacs 20.1
11727
11728 ** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
11729 options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
11730 at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
11731 tree structure.
11732
11733 M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
11734 user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
11735
11736 With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
11737 session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
11738 in your .emacs file.)
11739
11740 ** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
11741 You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
11742
11743 ** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
11744 This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
11745
11746 ** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
11747 immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
11748 kills the region.
11749
11750 The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
11751 delete the character before point, as usual.
11752
11753 ** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
11754 on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
11755 by setting search-highlight to nil.)
11756
11757 ** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
11758 insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
11759 the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
11760 onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
11761 history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
11762 past.)
11763
11764 ** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
11765 This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
11766 in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
11767 TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
11768 makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
11769
11770 As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
11771 and is an alias for it.
11772
11773 If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
11774 use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
11775
11776 ** Scrolling changes
11777
11778 *** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
11779 position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
11780
11781 In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
11782 on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
11783 where it started.
11784
11785 *** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
11786 move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
11787 screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
11788 does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
11789
11790 *** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
11791 top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
11792 comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
11793 recenters the window.
11794
11795 ** International character set support (MULE)
11796
11797 Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
11798 including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
11799 Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
11800 Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
11801 features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
11802 MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
11803
11804 Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
11805 coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
11806 character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
11807 variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
11808 into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
11809
11810 Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
11811 generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
11812 supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
11813 language, to make it possible to type them.
11814
11815 The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
11816 character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
11817
11818 The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
11819 to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
11820
11821 You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
11822
11823 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
11824
11825 Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
11826 characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
11827 argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
11828 already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
11829 characters for their work until they want to change.
11830
11831 *** Input methods
11832
11833 An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
11834 specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
11835 has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
11836 the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
11837 support several input methods.
11838
11839 The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
11840 another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
11841 work.
11842
11843 A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
11844 characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
11845 composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
11846 consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
11847 sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
11848 letter.
11849
11850 The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
11851 by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
11852 First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
11853 marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
11854 mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
11855
11856 None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
11857 they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
11858 phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
11859 converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
11860
11861 Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
11862 word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
11863 typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
11864 the first guess is wrong.
11865
11866 *** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
11867 turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
11868
11869 If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
11870 byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
11871 they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
11872 the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
11873
11874 However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
11875 use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
11876 includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
11877 translate automatically to and from either one.
11878
11879 *** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
11880
11881 Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
11882 file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
11883 sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
11884 what you want.
11885
11886 If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
11887 example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
11888 system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
11889 multibyte characters in that buffer.
11890
11891 If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
11892 character conversion as well.
11893
11894 *** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
11895
11896 A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
11897 Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
11898 requires using many fonts.
11899
11900 Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
11901 collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
11902
11903 A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
11904 the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
11905 have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
11906 you would use a font.
11907
11908 If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
11909 specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
11910 display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
11911
11912 The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
11913 (that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
11914 characters).
11915
11916 *** Defining fontsets.
11917
11918 Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
11919 chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
11920 with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
11921
11922 Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
11923 of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
11924 `fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
11925 standard fontset are created automatically.
11926
11927 If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
11928 argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
11929 FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
11930 with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
11931 name is `fontset-startup'.
11932
11933 Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
11934 The resource value should have this form:
11935 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
11936 FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
11937 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
11938 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
11939 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
11940 The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
11941 of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
11942 CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
11943 should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
11944
11945 Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
11946 last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
11947 You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
11948
11949 For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
11950 font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
11951 following resource,
11952 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
11953 the font for ASCII is generated as below:
11954 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
11955 Here is the substitution rule:
11956 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
11957 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
11958 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
11959 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
11960 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
11961
11962 The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
11963 fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
11964 that function explicitly to create a fontset.
11965
11966 With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
11967 like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
11968 name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
11969 fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
11970 fontsets.
11971
11972 *** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
11973 defaults for a particular choice of language.
11974
11975 Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
11976 method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
11977 visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
11978 already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
11979 language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
11980 system for new files that you create.
11981
11982 It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
11983 set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
11984 whole Emacs session.
11985
11986 For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
11987 chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
11988 with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
11989
11990 *** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
11991 specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
11992 specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
11993 the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
11994 coding systems that Emacs supports.
11995
11996 *** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
11997 lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
11998 This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
11999 After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
12000 is used for *the immediately following command*.
12001
12002 So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
12003 write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
12004
12005 If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
12006 then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
12007
12008 For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
12009 visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
12010
12011 *** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
12012 construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
12013 to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
12014 specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
12015 of the file.
12016
12017 *** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
12018 the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
12019 code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
12020 translated into that character code.
12021
12022 This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
12023 various countries to support the languages of those countries.
12024
12025 By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
12026
12027 *** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
12028 the coding system for keyboard input.
12029
12030 Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
12031 with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
12032 some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
12033
12034 By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
12035
12036 Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
12037 input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
12038 translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
12039 to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
12040 designed to work with terminals.
12041
12042 *** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
12043 specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
12044 This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
12045 has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
12046 translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
12047 in the corresponding buffer.
12048
12049 By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
12050
12051 *** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
12052 to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
12053 It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
12054
12055 *** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
12056 an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
12057 command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
12058 want to use.
12059
12060 C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
12061 method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
12062
12063 *** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
12064 layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
12065 remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
12066 which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
12067
12068 *** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
12069 the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
12070 related information.
12071
12072 *** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
12073 HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
12074 scripts.
12075
12076 *** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
12077 information about the support for a particular language.
12078 You specify the language as an argument.
12079
12080 *** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
12081 the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
12082 first dash.
12083
12084 A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
12085 (except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
12086 whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
12087 1 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
12088
12089 A alternativnyj (Russian)
12090 B big5 (Chinese)
12091 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
12092 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
12093 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
12094 E euc-japan (Japanese)
12095 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
12096 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
12097 K euc-korea (Korean)
12098 R koi8 (Russian)
12099 Q tibetan
12100 S shift_jis (Japanese)
12101 T lao
12102 T tis620 (Thai)
12103 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
12104 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
12105 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
12106 v viqr (Vietnamese)
12107 z hz (Chinese)
12108
12109 When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
12110 two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
12111 coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
12112 keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
12113
12114 *** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
12115 conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
12116
12117 When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
12118 into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
12119 rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
12120 Rmail files themselves.
12121
12122 *** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
12123 conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
12124
12125 Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
12126 for sending mail:
12127
12128 - If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
12129 - Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
12130 - Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
12131 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
12132 - Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
12133
12134 *** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
12135 to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
12136 Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
12137 translations.
12138
12139 ** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
12140 of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
12141 insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
12142 without any conversion.
12143
12144 ** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
12145 You can now specify any number of octal digits.
12146 RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
12147 any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
12148
12149 ** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
12150 functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
12151
12152 Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
12153 Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
12154
12155 Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
12156 mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
12157
12158 ** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
12159 complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
12160 in the buffer before point.
12161
12162 With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
12163 symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
12164 you are using.
12165
12166 With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
12167 just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
12168
12169 ** File locking works with NFS now.
12170
12171 The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
12172 in the same directory as FILENAME.
12173
12174 This means that collision detection between two different machines now
12175 works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
12176 can become a bottleneck.
12177
12178 The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
12179 does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
12180 create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
12181 file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
12182 rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
12183 so useful that the change is worth while.
12184
12185 When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
12186 are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
12187 collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
12188 tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
12189
12190 ** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
12191 it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
12192 show-paren-mode.
12193
12194 ** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
12195 selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
12196 delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
12197
12198 ** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
12199 within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
12200 complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
12201
12202 ** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
12203 it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
12204 set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
12205
12206 ** Changes in View mode.
12207
12208 *** Several new commands are available in View mode.
12209 Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
12210
12211 *** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
12212 view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
12213
12214 *** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
12215 previous state.
12216
12217 *** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
12218 scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
12219
12220 *** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
12221 non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
12222 not just the selected window.
12223
12224 *** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
12225 read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
12226 turns View mode on or off.
12227
12228 *** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
12229 how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
12230 delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
12231
12232 ** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
12233 now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
12234
12235 ** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
12236 has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
12237 presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
12238 which version to compare with.
12239
12240 ** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
12241 blocks if a match is inside the block.
12242
12243 The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
12244 is outside the block. By customizing the variable
12245 isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
12246 shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
12247
12248 By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
12249 of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
12250 blocks, all of them or none.
12251
12252 ** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
12253 current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
12254 confirmation first.
12255
12256 ** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
12257 now changes the major mode according to that file name.
12258 However, the mode will not be changed if
12259 (1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
12260 (2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
12261 not suitable for ordinary files, or
12262 (3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
12263
12264 This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
12265
12266 However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
12267 these commands do not change the major mode.
12268
12269 ** M-x occur changes.
12270
12271 *** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
12272 it performs a case-sensitive search.
12273
12274 *** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
12275 if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
12276 using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
12277
12278 ** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
12279 in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
12280 window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
12281 that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
12282 buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
12283
12284 ** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
12285 after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
12286 appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
12287 come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
12288
12289 ** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
12290 selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
12291 buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
12292
12293 ** Outline mode changes.
12294
12295 *** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
12296
12297 *** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
12298
12299 ** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
12300 you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
12301 Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
12302 was already active.
12303
12304 The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
12305 unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
12306 get confused by it.
12307
12308 If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
12309 set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
12310
12311 ** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
12312
12313 *** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
12314 conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
12315 character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
12316 including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
12317
12318 The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
12319 mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
12320 copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
12321
12322 *** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
12323 are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
12324 values.
12325
12326 `dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
12327 case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
12328 `dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
12329 case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
12330
12331 ** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
12332 certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
12333 can be. The default value is 30.
12334
12335 ** Changes in Mail mode.
12336
12337 *** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
12338 Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
12339 composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
12340 `mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
12341 `sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
12342 behavior.
12343
12344 C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
12345 compose-mail-other-frame.
12346
12347 *** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
12348 the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
12349 replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
12350 buffer that shows the original message.
12351
12352 *** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
12353 with separator lines around the contents.
12354
12355 *** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
12356 in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
12357 definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
12358 need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
12359
12360 *** New features in the mail-complete command.
12361
12362 **** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
12363 for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
12364 controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
12365 Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
12366
12367 **** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
12368 to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
12369 /etc/passwd.
12370
12371 **** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
12372 to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
12373 /etc/passwd.
12374
12375 ** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
12376 special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
12377 directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
12378 reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
12379
12380 Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
12381 when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
12382 be taken to be magic.
12383
12384 ** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
12385 files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
12386 available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
12387
12388 M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
12389 (-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
12390
12391 ** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
12392 suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
12393
12394 In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
12395
12396 new key dired.el binding old key
12397 ------- ---------------- -------
12398 * c dired-change-marks c
12399 * m dired-mark m
12400 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
12401 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
12402 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
12403 * u dired-unmark u
12404 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
12405 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
12406 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
12407 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
12408 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
12409 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
12410
12411 ** Rmail changes.
12412
12413 *** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
12414 saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
12415 chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
12416 each time you run it.
12417
12418 *** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
12419 whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
12420
12421 *** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
12422 messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
12423 means to move in the opposite direction.
12424
12425 *** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
12426 you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
12427
12428 *** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
12429 just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
12430 It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
12431 can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
12432 for output.
12433
12434 ** Gnus changes.
12435
12436 *** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
12437
12438 *** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
12439 Gnus.
12440
12441 *** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
12442 `and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
12443
12444 *** Article washing status can be displayed in the
12445 article mode line.
12446
12447 *** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
12448
12449 *** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
12450
12451 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
12452
12453 *** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
12454 are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
12455 `gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
12456
12457 *** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
12458
12459 *** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
12460
12461 *** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
12462 See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
12463
12464 *** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
12465 Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
12466 used to pick articles.
12467
12468 *** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
12469 another have been added.
12470
12471 `M-x gnus-change-server'
12472
12473 *** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
12474 generating lines in buffers.
12475
12476 *** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
12477 `C-M-_'.
12478
12479 *** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
12480
12481 *** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
12482
12483 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
12484
12485 *** Scores can be decayed.
12486
12487 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
12488
12489 *** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
12490 Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
12491
12492 *** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
12493 the native server.
12494
12495 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
12496
12497 *** A new command for reading collections of documents
12498 (nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
12499
12500 *** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
12501
12502 *** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
12503 even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
12504
12505 *** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
12506 (DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
12507
12508 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
12509 a group.
12510
12511 *** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
12512 sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
12513
12514 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
12515
12516 *** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
12517
12518 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
12519
12520 *** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
12521
12522 Use the `Y c' command.
12523
12524 *** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
12525
12526 *** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
12527
12528 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
12529
12530 *** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
12531 from incoming mail before saving the mail.
12532
12533 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
12534
12535 *** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
12536
12537 *** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
12538 the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
12539
12540 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
12541
12542 Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
12543 and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
12544 from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
12545 hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
12546 this issue.)
12547
12548 Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
12549 automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
12550 particular news group. This can be done by:
12551
12552 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
12553
12554 Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
12555 of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
12556 "XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
12557 system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
12558 for reading and posting).
12559
12560 CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
12561 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
12562 Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
12563 newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
12564 there.
12565
12566 Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
12567 default. Here are some of these default settings:
12568
12569 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
12570 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
12571 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
12572 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
12573 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
12574
12575 When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
12576 the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
12577
12578 ** CC mode changes.
12579
12580 *** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
12581 code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
12582 values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
12583 this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
12584 Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
12585 loaded.
12586
12587 If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
12588 Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
12589 style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
12590 share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
12591 c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
12592 must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
12593
12594 *** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
12595 of the current buffer.
12596
12597 *** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
12598 it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
12599 of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
12600
12601 *** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
12602 style that the Python developers like.
12603
12604 *** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
12605 This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
12606 just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
12607
12608 ** VC Changes [new]
12609
12610 *** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
12611 name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
12612 directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
12613
12614 This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
12615 master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
12616 developers.
12617
12618 You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
12619 RET in a buffer visiting that file.
12620
12621 *** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
12622 other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
12623 writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
12624 calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
12625
12626 *** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
12627 version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
12628
12629 ** Calendar changes.
12630
12631 *** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
12632 subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
12633 you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
12634 following/previous years.
12635
12636 *** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
12637 the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
12638 calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
12639 each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
12640 calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
12641 supposed attribute of God.
12642
12643 ** ps-print changes
12644
12645 There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
12646 layout.
12647
12648 *** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
12649
12650 Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
12651 be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
12652 printer system has this behavior, set variable
12653 `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
12654
12655 If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
12656 blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
12657 very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
12658
12659 The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
12660 setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
12661
12662 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
12663 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
12664 printing for your printer.
12665
12666 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
12667 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
12668
12669 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
12670 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
12671
12672 The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
12673 opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
12674 `ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
12675 bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
12676 ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
12677 This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
12678 The default value is nil.
12679
12680 The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
12681 properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
12682
12683 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
12684 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
12685 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
12686 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
12687 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
12688 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
12689 color). The default is 0 ("black").
12690
12691 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
12692 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
12693
12694 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
12695 The default is 0 ("black").
12696
12697 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
12698 The default is 0 ("black").
12699
12700 border-width Specify the border width.
12701 The default is 0.4.
12702
12703 Any other property is ignored.
12704
12705 Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
12706 `ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
12707 documentation).
12708
12709 Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
12710 `ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
12711 `ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
12712 `ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
12713 `ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
12714 controlling headers.
12715
12716 *** Color management (subgroup)
12717
12718 If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
12719 color.
12720
12721 *** Face Management (subgroup)
12722
12723 If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
12724 set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
12725 background should be used. Valid values are:
12726
12727 t always use face background color.
12728 nil never use face background color.
12729 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
12730
12731 *** N-up printing (subgroup)
12732
12733 The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
12734 sheet of paper.
12735
12736 The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
12737 between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
12738
12739 If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
12740 each page.
12741
12742 The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
12743 on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
12744 `ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
12745
12746 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
12747 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
12748 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
12749
12750 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
12751 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
12752 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
12753
12754 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
12755 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
12756 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
12757
12758 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
12759 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
12760 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
12761
12762 Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
12763
12764 *** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
12765
12766 The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
12767 RGB color.
12768
12769 The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
12770 continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
12771 to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
12772
12773 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
12774 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12775 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12776 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12777 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12778 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
12779 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
12780 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
12781 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12782 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12783 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12784 10 + 10 +
12785 11 + 11 +
12786 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12787 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12788 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
12789 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
12790 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
12791 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12792 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12793 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12794 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
12795 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
12796 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
12797 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
12798 22 + 22 +
12799 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12800
12801 Any other value is treated as `nil'.
12802
12803
12804 *** Printer management (subgroup)
12805
12806 The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
12807 some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
12808 `ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
12809 utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
12810 to "-P".
12811
12812 The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
12813 paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
12814 non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
12815
12816 The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
12817 should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
12818 do so.
12819
12820 *** Page settings (subgroup)
12821
12822 If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
12823 error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
12824 indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
12825 instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
12826 the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
12827 by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
12828 `setpagedevice'.
12829
12830 The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
12831 printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
12832 `upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
12833
12834 The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
12835 it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
12836 integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
12837 specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
12838 is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
12839 its TO, are ignored.
12840
12841 The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
12842 pages. Valid values are:
12843
12844 nil print all pages.
12845
12846 `even-page' print only even pages.
12847
12848 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
12849
12850 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
12851 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
12852 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
12853 print only the even sheet of paper.
12854
12855 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
12856 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
12857 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
12858 only the odd sheet of paper.
12859
12860 Any other value is treated as nil.
12861
12862 If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
12863 are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
12864 `ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
12865
12866 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
12867
12868 and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
12869 `ps-n-up-printing', we get:
12870
12871 `ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
12872 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
12873 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
12874 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
12875 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
12876 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
12877 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
12878
12879 `ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
12880 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
12881 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
12882 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
12883 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
12884 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
12885 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
12886
12887 *** Miscellany (subgroup)
12888
12889 The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
12890 messages should be sent.
12891
12892 It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
12893 front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
12894 `ps-user-defined-prologue'.
12895
12896 The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
12897
12898 The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
12899 points for line numbers.
12900
12901 The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
12902 numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
12903
12904 The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
12905 line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
12906 to 2, the printing will look like:
12907
12908 1 one line
12909 one line
12910 3 one line
12911 one line
12912 5 one line
12913 one line
12914 ...
12915
12916 Valid values are:
12917
12918 integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
12919 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
12920 is used.
12921
12922 `zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
12923 zebra stripe is to be printed.
12924
12925 Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
12926
12927 The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
12928 the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
12929 `ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
12930 3, the output will look like:
12931
12932 one line
12933 one line
12934 3 one line
12935 one line
12936 one line
12937 6 one line
12938 one line
12939 one line
12940 9 one line
12941 one line
12942 ...
12943
12944 The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
12945 where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
12946
12947 The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
12948 for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
12949 `ps-font-size').
12950
12951 The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
12952 in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
12953 `ps-font-size').
12954
12955 The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
12956
12957 The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
12958 start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
12959
12960 ** hideshow changes.
12961
12962 *** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
12963 C++, ; for lisp).
12964
12965 *** Support for java-mode added.
12966
12967 *** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
12968 in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
12969
12970 *** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
12971 the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
12972 way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
12973
12974 *** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
12975 robust and a lot faster.
12976
12977 *** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
12978
12979 *** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
12980 to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
12981 documentation for more details.
12982
12983 ** Changes in Enriched mode.
12984
12985 *** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
12986 filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
12987 of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
12988 use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
12989 the next time unless the fill-column is different.
12990
12991 *** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
12992 distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
12993 as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
12994 as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
12995
12996 ** Font Lock mode
12997
12998 *** Custom support
12999
13000 The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
13001 font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify the
13002 faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new custom
13003 group font-lock-highlighting-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in
13004 your ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
13005 consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
13006
13007 You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
13008
13009 *** Maximum decoration
13010
13011 Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
13012 default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
13013 of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
13014 supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
13015 to get the old behavior.
13016
13017 *** New support
13018
13019 Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
13020
13021 Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
13022 support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
13023
13024 *** Configurable support
13025
13026 Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
13027 additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
13028 c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
13029 java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
13030 list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
13031 of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
13032 convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
13033
13034 Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
13035 way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
13036 it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
13037
13038 *** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
13039
13040 You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
13041 highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
13042 for any mode.
13043
13044 For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
13045
13046 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
13047
13048 in your ~/.emacs.
13049
13050 *** New faces
13051
13052 Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
13053 font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
13054 distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
13055 to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
13056
13057 *** Changes to fast-lock support mode
13058
13059 The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
13060 cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
13061 same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
13062
13063 *** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
13064
13065 The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
13066 according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
13067 the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
13068 non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
13069 refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
13070 the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
13071 Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
13072
13073 This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
13074 For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
13075 this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
13076 refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
13077 containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
13078 the command M-o M-o (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
13079
13080 As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
13081
13082 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
13083 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
13084 Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
13085 new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
13086
13087 If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
13088 settings.
13089
13090 ** Ada mode changes.
13091
13092 *** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
13093 If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
13094 procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
13095 you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
13096 stubs.
13097
13098 *** There are two new commands:
13099 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
13100 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
13101
13102 The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
13103 `ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
13104 `ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
13105
13106 *** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
13107 is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
13108 Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
13109
13110 *** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
13111 formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
13112 places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
13113 space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
13114
13115 ** Scheme mode changes.
13116
13117 *** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
13118 mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
13119 for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
13120 with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
13121 have any effect.
13122
13123 If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
13124 still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
13125 scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
13126 variables as buffer-local variables.
13127
13128 *** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
13129 Use M-x dsssl-mode.
13130
13131 ** Changes to the emacsclient program
13132
13133 *** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
13134 USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
13135 associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
13136 can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
13137
13138 *** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
13139 it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
13140 buffer in Emacs.
13141
13142 *** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
13143 use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
13144 ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
13145 option takes precedence.
13146
13147 ** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
13148 constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
13149 (in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
13150
13151 ** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
13152 which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
13153 the current defun.
13154
13155 ** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
13156 following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
13157
13158 ** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
13159 and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
13160 necessary).
13161
13162 ** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
13163 if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
13164 these register values no longer become completely useless.
13165 If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
13166 asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
13167 it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
13168
13169 ** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
13170 example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
13171 be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
13172 you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
13173
13174 You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
13175 variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
13176 file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
13177 revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
13178 only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
13179
13180 ** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
13181 since it applies only to the current frame.
13182
13183 ** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
13184 file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
13185 and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
13186
13187 This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
13188 multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
13189 variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
13190 tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
13191 instead of just the file you are editing.
13192
13193 ** RefTeX mode
13194
13195 RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
13196 and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
13197 different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
13198 multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
13199 turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
13200
13201 C-c ( reftex-label
13202 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
13203 knows which kind of label is needed.
13204
13205 C-c ) reftex-reference
13206 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
13207 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
13208
13209 C-c [ reftex-citation
13210 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
13211 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
13212
13213 C-c & reftex-view-crossref
13214 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
13215
13216 C-c = reftex-toc
13217 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
13218 can quickly jump to every section.
13219
13220 Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
13221 commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
13222 Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
13223 reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
13224 C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
13225
13226 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
13227
13228 *** Info documentation is now available.
13229
13230 *** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
13231 both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
13232
13233 *** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
13234 bibtex-user-optional-fields.
13235
13236 *** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
13237 (use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
13238
13239 *** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
13240 entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
13241 appropriate functions.
13242
13243 *** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
13244 entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
13245
13246 *** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
13247 been cleaned.
13248
13249 *** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
13250 bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
13251
13252 *** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
13253 shall be delimited.
13254
13255 *** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
13256 bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
13257 bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
13258
13259 *** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
13260 field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
13261 prefixed with `ALT'.
13262
13263 *** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
13264 bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
13265 formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
13266 documentation).
13267
13268 *** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
13269 documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
13270 for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
13271
13272 *** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
13273 comma should be inserted at end of last field.
13274
13275 *** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
13276 alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
13277 signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
13278
13279 *** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
13280
13281 *** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
13282
13283 *** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
13284 from alien sources.
13285
13286 *** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
13287 to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
13288 crossref entries.
13289
13290 *** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
13291 region.
13292
13293 *** Added support for imenu.
13294
13295 *** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
13296 of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
13297 `compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
13298 `next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
13299
13300 *** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
13301 from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
13302
13303 ** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
13304
13305 ** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
13306
13307 ** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
13308 functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
13309 Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
13310 as an argument.
13311
13312 When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
13313 and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
13314
13315 ** browse-url changes
13316
13317 *** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
13318 Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
13319 (browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
13320 non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
13321 customization variables.
13322
13323 *** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
13324
13325 *** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
13326 lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
13327 (e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
13328
13329 ** Changes in Ediff
13330
13331 *** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
13332 pops up the Info file for this command.
13333
13334 *** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
13335 the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
13336 merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
13337 directories).
13338
13339 *** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
13340 and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
13341 files in the same directory.
13342
13343 *** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
13344 The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
13345 related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
13346
13347 ** Changes in Viper
13348
13349 *** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
13350 *** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
13351 instead of vip-.
13352 *** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
13353 *** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
13354 Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
13355 *** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
13356 *** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
13357 *** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
13358 color when Viper is in insert state.
13359 *** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
13360 Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
13361 viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
13362
13363 ** Etags changes.
13364
13365 *** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
13366 default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
13367 Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
13368 variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
13369 not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
13370
13371 *** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
13372
13373 *** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
13374 constructs are tagged. Files are recognised by the extension .java.
13375
13376 *** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
13377 recognised by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
13378 In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
13379
13380 *** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
13381 C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
13382 recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
13383 methods and protocols.
13384
13385 *** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognised by the extension
13386 .cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
13387 column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
13388 paragraph name.
13389
13390 *** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
13391 an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
13392 at least M times and as many as N times.
13393
13394 ** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
13395 in files has changed slightly.
13396
13397 With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
13398 time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
13399 This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
13400 with old time-stamp-format values.
13401
13402 In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
13403 (`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
13404 This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
13405 reasons.
13406
13407 In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
13408 natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
13409 fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
13410 (`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
13411 time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
13412 specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
13413
13414 Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
13415 case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
13416 truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
13417
13418 The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
13419 being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
13420 future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
13421 recommended now will continue to work then.
13422
13423 See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
13424 details.
13425
13426 ** There are some additional major modes:
13427
13428 dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
13429 m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
13430 meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
13431
13432 ** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
13433 copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
13434 into Emacs.
13435
13436 ** New Lisp packages include:
13437
13438 *** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
13439
13440 *** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
13441 be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
13442
13443 *** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
13444
13445 *** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
13446 in shell buffers.
13447
13448 *** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
13449 See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
13450 and `elint-defun'.
13451
13452 *** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
13453 meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
13454 ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
13455 strings or comments.
13456
13457 These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
13458 abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
13459 you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
13460 insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
13461 at these points.
13462
13463 *** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
13464 can visit them by short forms of their names.
13465
13466 *** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
13467 Emacs Lisp function at point.
13468
13469 *** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
13470
13471 *** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
13472 switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
13473
13474 *** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
13475
13476 *** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
13477
13478 *** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
13479
13480 *** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
13481 from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
13482
13483 *** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
13484 You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
13485 inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
13486 original place after inserting the copy.
13487
13488 *** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
13489 on the buffer.
13490
13491 You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
13492 velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
13493 (with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
13494
13495 Enable mouse-drag with:
13496 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
13497 -or-
13498 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
13499
13500 *** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
13501 mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
13502
13503 *** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
13504 It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
13505
13506 *** ogonek
13507
13508 The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
13509 Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
13510 platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
13511 TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
13512 ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
13513 prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
13514 instance) and vice versa.
13515
13516 To use this package load it using
13517 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
13518 Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
13519 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
13520 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
13521 The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
13522 ways of customization in `.emacs'.
13523
13524 *** Interface to ph.
13525
13526 Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
13527
13528 The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
13529 services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
13530 these servers.
13531
13532 *** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
13533
13534 *** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
13535 You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
13536 while the real cursor does not move.
13537
13538 *** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
13539 for visiting your favorite web sites.
13540
13541 *** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
13542 so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
13543
13544 ** movemail change
13545
13546 Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
13547 mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
13548 supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
13549 user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
13550
13551 This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
13552 \f
13553 * Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
13554
13555 ** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
13556
13557 Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
13558 end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
13559 Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
13560 file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
13561 file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
13562
13563 To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
13564 C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
13565 coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
13566 specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
13567 LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
13568 save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
13569 \f
13570 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
13571
13572 ** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
13573 Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
13574 vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
13575 Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
13576
13577 ** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
13578 to start with w32- instead of win32-.
13579
13580 In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
13581 don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
13582 "win".
13583
13584 ** Basic Lisp changes
13585
13586 *** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
13587 evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
13588
13589 *** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
13590 be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
13591 or by the user.
13592
13593 The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
13594
13595 *** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
13596
13597 (when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
13598 (unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
13599
13600 *** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
13601 usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
13602 its argument.
13603
13604 *** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
13605
13606 *** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
13607
13608 *** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
13609
13610 *** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
13611 error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
13612 include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
13613 `format' function.
13614
13615 *** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
13616 or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
13617 whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
13618
13619 *** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
13620 either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
13621 adding one of these suffixes.
13622
13623 *** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
13624 which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
13625 If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
13626
13627 We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
13628 because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
13629
13630 *** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
13631
13632 *** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
13633 You must load the `cl' library to define it.
13634
13635 *** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
13636 conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
13637
13638 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
13639
13640 BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
13641 BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
13642
13643 *** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
13644 choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
13645 restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
13646 works using `save-current-buffer'.
13647
13648 *** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
13649 write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
13650 of the last form.
13651
13652 *** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
13653 which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
13654 last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
13655 as the last form.
13656
13657 *** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
13658 characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
13659 matches.
13660
13661 For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
13662
13663 *** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
13664 with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
13665 Then it returns that string.
13666
13667 For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
13668
13669 (with-output-to-string
13670 (princ "The buffer is ")
13671 (princ (buffer-name)))
13672
13673 returns "The buffer is foo".
13674
13675 ** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
13676 is non-nil.
13677
13678 These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
13679 buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
13680 characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
13681
13682 *** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
13683 a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
13684
13685 Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
13686 character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
13687 Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
13688 position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
13689 characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
13690 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
13691
13692 ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
13693 Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
13694 non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
13695 characters".
13696
13697 The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
13698 through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
13699 "leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
13700 range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
13701 leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
13702
13703 *** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
13704 (forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
13705 multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
13706 character, which may be more than one buffer position.
13707
13708 This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
13709 always one buffer position, need to be changed.
13710
13711 However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
13712
13713 *** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
13714 because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
13715 have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
13716 the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
13717 guaranteed.
13718
13719 *** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
13720 between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
13721 character).
13722
13723 When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
13724
13725 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
13726 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
13727 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
13728 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
13729 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
13730
13731 *** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
13732
13733 *** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
13734 `length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
13735 more than the number of characters.
13736
13737 You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
13738 it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
13739 \xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
13740 is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
13741 follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
13742 newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
13743
13744 *** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
13745 and returns a string containing those characters.
13746
13747 *** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
13748 (sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
13749 counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
13750 character, sref signals an error.
13751
13752 *** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
13753 in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
13754 string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
13755
13756 *** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
13757 in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
13758 region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
13759
13760 *** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
13761 the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
13762 to a vector of the characters in it.
13763
13764 *** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
13765 of a string. You call it as follows:
13766
13767 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
13768
13769 This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
13770 STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
13771 This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
13772 Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
13773 it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
13774
13775 *** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
13776 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
13777
13778 *** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
13779 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
13780
13781 *** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
13782 to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
13783 not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
13784 which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
13785
13786 (truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
13787
13788 This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
13789
13790 The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
13791 If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
13792 are not included in the resulting value.
13793
13794 The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
13795 at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
13796 WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
13797 is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
13798
13799 If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
13800 place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
13801 character extends across that column), then the padding character
13802 PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
13803 string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
13804 column START-COLUMN.
13805
13806 *** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
13807 the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
13808 necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
13809 difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
13810 changed text, before the change.
13811
13812 *** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
13813 sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
13814 one character set for each script, not for each language.
13815
13816 **** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
13817
13818 **** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
13819
13820 **** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
13821 set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
13822
13823 **** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
13824 name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
13825 which identify the character within that character set.
13826
13827 **** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
13828 byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
13829 opposite of split-char.
13830
13831 **** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
13832 of all the characters between BEG and END.
13833
13834 **** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
13835 of all the characters in a string.
13836
13837 *** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
13838 and specifying coding systems.
13839
13840 **** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
13841 system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
13842 of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
13843 (Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
13844 and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
13845 as what to do about code conversion.)
13846
13847 **** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
13848 name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
13849
13850 **** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
13851 for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
13852 except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
13853
13854 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
13855 which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
13856 to match against a file name.
13857
13858 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
13859 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
13860 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
13861 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
13862 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
13863 specifies the coding system for encoding.
13864
13865 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
13866 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
13867
13868 **** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
13869 the coding system to use for network sockets.
13870
13871 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
13872 which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
13873 either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
13874 service names.
13875
13876 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
13877 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
13878 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
13879 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
13880 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
13881 specifies the coding system for encoding.
13882
13883 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
13884 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
13885
13886 **** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
13887 for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
13888 except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
13889 start the subprocess.
13890
13891 **** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
13892 systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
13893 when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
13894 (OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
13895 to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
13896
13897 **** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
13898 coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
13899 subprocess.
13900
13901 It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
13902 but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
13903 start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
13904 connection permanently or until overridden.
13905
13906 The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
13907 file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
13908 network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
13909 coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
13910 It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
13911 system for one operation at a time.
13912
13913 **** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
13914 files, subprocesses or network connections.
13915
13916 **** The function process-coding-system tells you what
13917 coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
13918 The value is a cons cell,
13919 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
13920 where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
13921 the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
13922 input to the subprocess.
13923
13924 **** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
13925 change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
13926
13927 ** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
13928 customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
13929 you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
13930
13931 You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
13932 variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
13933 information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
13934 legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
13935 customization.
13936
13937 Thus, instead of writing
13938
13939 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
13940 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
13941
13942 you would now write this:
13943
13944 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
13945 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
13946 :type 'boolean
13947 :group foo)
13948
13949 The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
13950 two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
13951 describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
13952 for a description of them.
13953
13954 The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
13955 should belong to. You define a new group like this:
13956
13957 (defgroup ispell nil
13958 "Spell checking using Ispell."
13959 :group 'processes)
13960
13961 The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
13962 group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
13963 but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
13964 to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
13965 second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
13966
13967 Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
13968 package should have just one group; a more complex package should
13969 have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
13970 package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
13971 first-level subgroups.
13972
13973 ** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
13974
13975 This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
13976 separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
13977
13978 ** easy-mmode
13979
13980 The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
13981 developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
13982 only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
13983 predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
13984 `easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
13985 `easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
13986
13987 ** Text property changes
13988
13989 *** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
13990 text property.
13991
13992 *** The new functions next-char-property-change and
13993 previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
13994 place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
13995 functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
13996 starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
13997
13998 If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
13999 LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
14000 of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
14001 position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
14002
14003 *** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
14004 value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
14005 is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
14006
14007 ** Changes in invisibility features
14008
14009 *** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
14010 hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
14011 is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
14012 should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
14013 would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
14014 make the overlay visible.
14015
14016 During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
14017 invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
14018 needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
14019 which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
14020 the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
14021 t when it should hide it.
14022
14023 *** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
14024
14025 Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
14026 invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
14027 and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
14028 Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
14029 manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
14030 Here is an example of how to do this:
14031
14032 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
14033 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
14034 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
14035 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
14036
14037 ...
14038 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
14039
14040 ...
14041 ;; When done with the overlays:
14042 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
14043 ;; Or respectively:
14044 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
14045
14046 ** Changes in syntax parsing.
14047
14048 *** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
14049 `parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
14050 obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
14051 `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
14052
14053 If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
14054 is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
14055 used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
14056
14057 When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
14058 character in the buffer is calculated thus:
14059
14060 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
14061 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
14062
14063 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
14064 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
14065 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
14066
14067 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
14068 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
14069 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
14070 determine the syntax type of the character.
14071
14072 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
14073 of the current buffer.
14074
14075 *** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
14076 value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
14077 for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
14078
14079 *** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
14080 and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
14081 only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
14082 character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
14083 another character with the same code (unless quoted).
14084
14085 These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
14086 text property.
14087
14088 *** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
14089 arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
14090 of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
14091
14092 *** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
14093 (and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
14094 element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
14095 nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
14096 string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
14097
14098 *** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
14099 syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
14100 `font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
14101
14102 ** Changes in face features
14103
14104 *** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
14105 if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
14106
14107 *** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
14108 of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
14109
14110 *** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
14111 set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
14112
14113 *** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
14114 set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
14115
14116 *** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
14117 by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
14118 and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
14119 the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
14120 overlay property).
14121
14122 This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
14123 arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
14124
14125 ** Changes in file-handling functions
14126
14127 *** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
14128 directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
14129 they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
14130 is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
14131
14132 This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
14133 begins with ~.
14134
14135 *** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
14136 it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
14137
14138 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
14139 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
14140
14141 *** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
14142 as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
14143
14144 *** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
14145 character code conversion as well as other things.
14146
14147 Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
14148 (formerly it did not).
14149
14150 *** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
14151 environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
14152
14153 *** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
14154 instead of constant strings.
14155
14156 *** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
14157 to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
14158 any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
14159
14160 substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
14161 in the same way as before.
14162
14163 *** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
14164 The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
14165 which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
14166
14167 *** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
14168 error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
14169 else, and returns nil.
14170
14171 *** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
14172 directory cannot be listed.
14173
14174 ** Changes in minibuffer input
14175
14176 *** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
14177 read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
14178 additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
14179 argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
14180 ways:
14181
14182 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
14183 It is available through the history command M-n.
14184
14185 *** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
14186 read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
14187 argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
14188 minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
14189 enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
14190
14191 In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
14192 argument in this way.
14193
14194 *** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
14195 from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
14196 minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
14197
14198 ** Echo area features
14199
14200 *** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
14201 echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
14202 minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
14203 after the echo area is cleared.
14204
14205 *** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
14206 in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
14207
14208 ** Keyboard input features
14209
14210 *** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
14211 set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
14212
14213 *** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
14214 received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
14215 by keyboard macros.
14216
14217 ** Frame-related changes
14218
14219 *** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
14220 creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
14221 hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
14222
14223 *** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
14224 the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
14225 has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
14226
14227 *** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
14228 selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
14229 value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
14230 in the selected frame.
14231
14232 *** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
14233 is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
14234 which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
14235
14236 ** X Windows features
14237
14238 *** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
14239 x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
14240 x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
14241
14242 *** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
14243 The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
14244
14245 *** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
14246 MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
14247 A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
14248
14249 If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
14250 it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
14251
14252 ** Subprocess features
14253
14254 *** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
14255 functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
14256 automatically.
14257
14258 *** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
14259 and returns the output from the command as a string.
14260
14261 *** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
14262 and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
14263
14264 ** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
14265 does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
14266
14267 ** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
14268 at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
14269 goes after the other menu items.
14270
14271 ** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
14272 of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
14273 around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
14274 are in use.
14275
14276 The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
14277 series of several changes--if that seems safe.
14278
14279 Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
14280 after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
14281 form.
14282
14283 ** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
14284 is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
14285 but its hook is still run.
14286
14287 ** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
14288 for errors that are handled by condition-case.
14289
14290 If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
14291 regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
14292 useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
14293
14294 This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
14295 are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
14296 filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
14297 warned.
14298
14299 ** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
14300 way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
14301
14302 ** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
14303 integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
14304 functions like display-time.
14305
14306 ** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
14307 name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
14308
14309 ** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
14310 can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
14311 is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
14312
14313 ** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
14314 if there is an error in compilation.
14315
14316 ** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
14317 switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
14318 argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
14319 they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
14320
14321 ** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
14322 Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
14323 the *scratch* buffer.
14324
14325 ** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
14326 The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
14327 where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
14328 e.g., in Font Lock mode.
14329
14330 ** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
14331 and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
14332 It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
14333
14334 ** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
14335 using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
14336 variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
14337 and compose-mail-other-frame.
14338
14339 ** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
14340 can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
14341 full name of the specified user will be returned.
14342
14343 ** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
14344 of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
14345 where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
14346 in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
14347 option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
14348 files at all.
14349
14350 ** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
14351 and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
14352 width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
14353 the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
14354
14355 For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
14356 minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
14357 with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
14358 is how %S normally pads to two positions.
14359
14360 ** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
14361
14362 ** imenu.el changes.
14363
14364 You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
14365 item from menu created by imenu.
14366
14367 An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
14368 #include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
14369 select one of those items.
14370 \f
14371 * For older news, see the file ONEWS
14372
14373 ----------------------------------------------------------------------
14374 Copyright information:
14375
14376 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
14377
14378 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
14379 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
14380 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
14381 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
14382
14383 Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
14384 of this document, or of portions of it,
14385 under the above conditions, provided also that they
14386 carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
14387 \f
14388 Local variables:
14389 mode: outline
14390 paragraph-separate: "[ \f]*$"
14391 end:
14392
14393 arch-tag: 1aca9dfa-2ac4-4d14-bebf-0007cee12793